• Home
  • Line#
  • Scopes#
  • Navigate#
  • Raw
  • Download
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
27 #include <net/regulatory.h>
28 
29 /**
30  * DOC: Introduction
31  *
32  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
33  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
34  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
35  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
36  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
37  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
38  *
39  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
40  * use restrictions.
41  */
42 
43 
44 /**
45  * DOC: Device registration
46  *
47  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
48  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
49  * described below.
50  *
51  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
52  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
53  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
54  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
55  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
56  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
57  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
58  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
59  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
60  *
61  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
62  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
63  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
64  */
65 
66 struct wiphy;
67 
68 /*
69  * wireless hardware capability structures
70  */
71 
72 /**
73  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
74  *
75  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
76  *
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
78  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
79  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
80  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
82  *	is not permitted.
83  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
84  *	is not permitted.
85  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
86  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
87  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
88  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
89  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
90  *	restrictions.
91  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
92  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
93  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
94  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
95  *	restrictions.
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
99  *	on this channel.
100  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
101  *	on this channel.
102  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
104  *	on this channel.
105  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106  *	on this channel.
107  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108  *	on this channel.
109  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
110  *	on this channel.
111  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
112  *	on this channel.
113  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
114  *	this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
115  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
116  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
117  *	restrictions.
118  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
119  */
120 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
123 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
134 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
135 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
136 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
137 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
138 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
139 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
140 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ	= 1<<19,
141 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT		= 1<<20,
142 };
143 
144 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
145 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
146 
147 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
149 
150 /**
151  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
152  *
153  * This structure describes a single channel for use
154  * with cfg80211.
155  *
156  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
157  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
158  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
159  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
160  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
161  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
162  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
163  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
164  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
165  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
166  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
167  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
168  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
169  * @orig_mag: internal use
170  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
171  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
172  *	on this channel.
173  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
174  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
175  */
176 struct ieee80211_channel {
177 	enum nl80211_band band;
178 	u32 center_freq;
179 	u16 freq_offset;
180 	u16 hw_value;
181 	u32 flags;
182 	int max_antenna_gain;
183 	int max_power;
184 	int max_reg_power;
185 	bool beacon_found;
186 	u32 orig_flags;
187 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
188 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
189 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
190 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
191 };
192 
193 /**
194  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
195  *
196  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
197  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
198  * different bands/PHY modes.
199  *
200  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
201  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
202  *	with CCK rates.
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
204  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
205  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
206  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
207  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
208  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
209  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
210  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
211  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
212  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
213  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
214  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
215  */
216 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
217 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
218 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
219 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
220 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
221 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
222 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
223 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
228  *
229  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
230  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
231  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
232  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
233  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
234  */
235 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
236 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
237 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
238 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
239 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
240 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
245  *
246  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
247  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
248  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
249  */
250 enum ieee80211_privacy {
251 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
252 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
253 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
254 };
255 
256 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
257 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
258 
259 /**
260  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
261  *
262  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
263  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
264  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
265  * passed around.
266  *
267  * @flags: rate-specific flags
268  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
269  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
270  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
271  *	short preamble is used
272  */
273 struct ieee80211_rate {
274 	u32 flags;
275 	u16 bitrate;
276 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
277 };
278 
279 /**
280  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
281  *
282  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
283  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
284  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
285  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
286  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
287  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
288  *	members of the SRG
289  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
290  *	used by members of the SRG
291  */
292 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
293 	bool enable;
294 	u8 sr_ctrl;
295 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
296 	u8 min_offset;
297 	u8 max_offset;
298 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
299 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
300 };
301 
302 /**
303  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
304  *
305  * @color: the current color.
306  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
307  * @partial: define the AID equation.
308  */
309 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
310 	u8 color;
311 	bool enabled;
312 	bool partial;
313 };
314 
315 /**
316  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
317  *
318  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
319  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
320  *
321  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
322  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
323  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
324  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
325  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
326  */
327 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
328 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
329 	bool ht_supported;
330 	u8 ampdu_factor;
331 	u8 ampdu_density;
332 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
333 };
334 
335 /**
336  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
337  *
338  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
339  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
340  *
341  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
342  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
343  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
344  */
345 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
346 	bool vht_supported;
347 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
348 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
349 };
350 
351 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
352 
353 /**
354  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
355  *
356  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
357  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
358  *
359  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
360  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
361  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
362  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
363  */
364 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
365 	bool has_he;
366 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
367 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
368 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
369 };
370 
371 /**
372  * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
373  *
374  * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
375  * and NSS Set field"
376  *
377  * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
378  * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
379  * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
380  * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
381  * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
382  */
383 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
384 	union {
385 		struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
386 		struct {
387 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
388 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
389 			struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
390 		} __packed bw;
391 	} __packed;
392 } __packed;
393 
394 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		32
395 
396 /**
397  * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
398  *
399  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
400  * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
401  *
402  * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
403  * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
404  * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
405  * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
406  */
407 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
408 	bool has_eht;
409 	struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
410 	struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
411 	u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
412 };
413 
414 /**
415  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
416  *
417  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
418  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
419  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
420  *
421  * @types_mask: interface types mask
422  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
423  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
424  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
425  * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
426  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
427  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
428  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
429  */
430 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
431 	u16 types_mask;
432 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
433 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
434 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
435 	struct {
436 		const u8 *data;
437 		unsigned int len;
438 	} vendor_elems;
439 };
440 
441 /**
442  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
443  *
444  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
445  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
446  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
447  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
448  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
449  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
450  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
451  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
452  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
453  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
454  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
455  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
456  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
457  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
458  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
459  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
460  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
461  */
462 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
463 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
464 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
465 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
466 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
467 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
468 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
469 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
470 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
471 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
472 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
473 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
474 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
475 };
476 
477 /**
478  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
479  *
480  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
481  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
482  *
483  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
484  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
485  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
486  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
487  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
488  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
489  */
490 struct ieee80211_edmg {
491 	u8 channels;
492 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
493 };
494 
495 /**
496  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
497  *
498  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
499  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
500  *
501  * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
502  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
503  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
504  */
505 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
506 	bool s1g;
507 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
508 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
509 };
510 
511 /**
512  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
513  *
514  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
515  * is able to operate in.
516  *
517  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
518  *	in this band.
519  * @band: the band this structure represents
520  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
521  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
522  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
523  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
524  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
525  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
526  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
527  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
528  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
529  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
530  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
531  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
532  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
533  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
534  *	iftype_data).
535  */
536 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
537 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
538 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
539 	enum nl80211_band band;
540 	int n_channels;
541 	int n_bitrates;
542 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
543 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
544 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
545 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
546 	u16 n_iftype_data;
547 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
548 };
549 
550 /**
551  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
552  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
553  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
554  *
555  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
556  */
557 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)558 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
559 				u8 iftype)
560 {
561 	int i;
562 
563 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
564 		return NULL;
565 
566 	if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
567 		iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
568 
569 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
570 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
571 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
572 
573 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
574 			return data;
575 	}
576 
577 	return NULL;
578 }
579 
580 /**
581  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
582  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
583  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
584  *
585  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
586  */
587 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)588 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
589 			    u8 iftype)
590 {
591 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
592 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
593 
594 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
595 		return &data->he_cap;
596 
597 	return NULL;
598 }
599 
600 /**
601  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
602  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
603  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
604  *
605  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
606  */
607 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)608 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
609 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
610 {
611 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
612 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
613 
614 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
615 		return 0;
616 
617 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
618 }
619 
620 /**
621  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
622  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
623  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
624  *
625  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
626  */
627 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)628 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
629 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
630 {
631 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
632 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
633 
634 	if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
635 		return &data->eht_cap;
636 
637 	return NULL;
638 }
639 
640 /**
641  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
642  *
643  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
644  *
645  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
646  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
647  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
648  *
649  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
650  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
651  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
652  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
653  * without affecting other devices.
654  *
655  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
656  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
657  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
658  */
659 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
660 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
661 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)662 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
663 {
664 }
665 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
666 
667 
668 /*
669  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
670  */
671 
672 /**
673  * DOC: Actions and configuration
674  *
675  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
676  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
677  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
678  * operations use are described separately.
679  *
680  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
681  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
682  *
683  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
684  * in a separate chapter.
685  */
686 
687 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
688 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
689 
690 /**
691  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
692  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
693  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
694  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
695  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
696  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
697  *	determine the address as needed.
698  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
699  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
700  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
701  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
702  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
703  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
704  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
705  */
706 struct vif_params {
707 	u32 flags;
708 	int use_4addr;
709 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
710 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
711 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
712 };
713 
714 /**
715  * struct key_params - key information
716  *
717  * Information about a key
718  *
719  * @key: key material
720  * @key_len: length of key material
721  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
722  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
723  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
724  *	length given by @seq_len.
725  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
726  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
727  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
728  */
729 struct key_params {
730 	const u8 *key;
731 	const u8 *seq;
732 	int key_len;
733 	int seq_len;
734 	u16 vlan_id;
735 	u32 cipher;
736 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
737 };
738 
739 /**
740  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
741  * @chan: the (control) channel
742  * @width: channel width
743  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
744  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
745  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
746  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
747  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
748  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
749  *	parameters are ignored.
750  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
751  */
752 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
753 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
754 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
755 	u32 center_freq1;
756 	u32 center_freq2;
757 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
758 	u16 freq1_offset;
759 };
760 
761 /*
762  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
763  */
764 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
765 	struct {
766 		u32 legacy;
767 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
768 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
769 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
770 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
771 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
772 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
773 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
774 };
775 
776 
777 /**
778  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
779  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
780  *	of the peer.
781  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
782  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
783  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
784  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
785  * @retry_long: retry count value
786  * @retry_short: retry count value
787  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
788  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
789  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
790  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
791  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
792  */
793 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
794 	bool config_override;
795 	u8 tids;
796 	u64 mask;
797 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
798 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
799 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
800 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
801 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
802 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
803 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
804 };
805 
806 /**
807  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
808  * @peer: Station's MAC address
809  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
810  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
811  */
812 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
813 	const u8 *peer;
814 	u32 n_tid_conf;
815 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
816 };
817 
818 /**
819  * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
820  * @macaddr: STA MAC address
821  * @kek: FILS KEK
822  * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
823  * @snonce: STA Nonce
824  * @anonce: AP Nonce
825  */
826 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
827 	const u8 *macaddr;
828 	const u8 *kek;
829 	u8 kek_len;
830 	const u8 *snonce;
831 	const u8 *anonce;
832 };
833 
834 /**
835  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
836  * @chandef: the channel definition
837  *
838  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
839  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
840  */
841 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)842 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
843 {
844 	switch (chandef->width) {
845 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
846 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
847 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
848 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
849 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
850 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
851 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
852 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
853 	default:
854 		WARN_ON(1);
855 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
856 	}
857 }
858 
859 /**
860  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
861  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
862  * @channel: the control channel
863  * @chantype: the channel type
864  *
865  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
866  */
867 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
868 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
869 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
870 
871 /**
872  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
873  * @chandef1: first channel definition
874  * @chandef2: second channel definition
875  *
876  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
877  * identical, %false otherwise.
878  */
879 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)880 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
881 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
882 {
883 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
884 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
885 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
886 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
887 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
888 }
889 
890 /**
891  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
892  *
893  * @chandef: the channel definition
894  *
895  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
896  */
897 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)898 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
899 {
900 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
901 }
902 
903 /**
904  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
905  * @chandef1: first channel definition
906  * @chandef2: second channel definition
907  *
908  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
909  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
910  */
911 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
912 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
913 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
914 
915 /**
916  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
917  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
918  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
919  */
920 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
921 
922 /**
923  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
924  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
925  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
926  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
927  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
928  */
929 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
930 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
931 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
932 
933 /**
934  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
935  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
936  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
937  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
938  * Returns:
939  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
940  */
941 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
942 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
943 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
944 
945 /**
946  * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
947  * @width: the channel width of the channel
948  *
949  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
950  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
951  *
952  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
953  */
954 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)955 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
956 {
957 	switch (width) {
958 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
959 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
960 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
961 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
962 	default:
963 		break;
964 	}
965 	return 0;
966 }
967 
968 /**
969  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
970  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
971  *
972  * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
973  *
974  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
975  */
976 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)977 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
978 {
979 	return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
980 }
981 
982 /**
983  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
984  *
985  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
986  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
987  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
988  *
989  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
990  *
991  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
992  */
993 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)994 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
995 {
996 	switch (chandef->width) {
997 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
998 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
999 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1000 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1001 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1002 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
1003 	default:
1004 		break;
1005 	}
1006 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
1007 }
1008 
1009 /**
1010  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1011  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1012  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1013  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1014  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1015  */
1016 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1017 				  unsigned long band_mask,
1018 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
1019 
1020 /**
1021  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1022  *
1023  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1024  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1025  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1026  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1027  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1028  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1029  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1030  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1031  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1032  *
1033  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1034  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1035  */
1036 enum survey_info_flags {
1037 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
1038 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
1039 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
1040 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
1041 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
1042 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
1043 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
1044 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
1045 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
1046 };
1047 
1048 /**
1049  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1050  *
1051  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1052  *	record to report global statistics
1053  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1054  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1055  *	optional
1056  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1057  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1058  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1059  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1060  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1061  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1062  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1063  *
1064  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1065  *
1066  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1067  * channel duty cycle etc.
1068  */
1069 struct survey_info {
1070 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1071 	u64 time;
1072 	u64 time_busy;
1073 	u64 time_ext_busy;
1074 	u64 time_rx;
1075 	u64 time_tx;
1076 	u64 time_scan;
1077 	u64 time_bss_rx;
1078 	u32 filled;
1079 	s8 noise;
1080 };
1081 
1082 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
1083 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES	10
1084 
1085 /**
1086  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1087  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1088  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1089  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1090  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1091  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1092  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1093  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1094  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1095  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1096  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1097  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1098  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1099  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1100  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1101  *	protocol frames.
1102  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1103  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1104  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1105  *	port for mac80211
1106  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1107  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1108  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1109  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1110  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1111  *	offload)
1112  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1113  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1114  *
1115  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1116  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1117  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1118  *	  such a scenario.
1119  *
1120  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1121  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1122  *
1123  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1124  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1125  *
1126  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1127  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1128  */
1129 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1130 	u32 wpa_versions;
1131 	u32 cipher_group;
1132 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1133 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1134 	int n_akm_suites;
1135 	u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1136 	bool control_port;
1137 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1138 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1139 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1140 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1141 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1142 	int wep_tx_key;
1143 	const u8 *psk;
1144 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1145 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1146 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1147 
1148 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1149 };
1150 
1151 /**
1152  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1153  *
1154  * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1155  * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1156  * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1157  */
1158 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1159 	struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1160 	u8 index;
1161 	bool ema;
1162 };
1163 
1164 /**
1165  * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1166  *
1167  * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1168  *
1169  * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1170  * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1171  * @elem.len: Length of data.
1172  */
1173 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1174 	u8 cnt;
1175 	struct {
1176 		const u8 *data;
1177 		size_t len;
1178 	} elem[];
1179 };
1180 
1181 /**
1182  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1183  * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1184  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1185  *	or %NULL if not changed
1186  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1187  *	or %NULL if not changed
1188  * @head_len: length of @head
1189  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1190  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1191  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1192  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1193  *	frames or %NULL
1194  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1195  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1196  *	Response frames or %NULL
1197  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1198  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1199  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1200  * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1201  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1202  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1203  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1204  *	(measurement type 8)
1205  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1206  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1207  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1208  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1209  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1210  * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1211  *	attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1212  */
1213 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1214 	unsigned int link_id;
1215 
1216 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1217 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1218 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1219 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1220 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1221 	const u8 *lci;
1222 	const u8 *civicloc;
1223 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1224 	s8 ftm_responder;
1225 
1226 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1227 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1228 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1229 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1230 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1231 	size_t lci_len;
1232 	size_t civicloc_len;
1233 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1234 	bool he_bss_color_valid;
1235 
1236 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1237 };
1238 
1239 struct mac_address {
1240 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1241 };
1242 
1243 /**
1244  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1245  *
1246  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1247  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1248  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1249  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1250  */
1251 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1252 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1253 	int n_acl_entries;
1254 
1255 	/* Keep it last */
1256 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1257 };
1258 
1259 /**
1260  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1261  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1262  *
1263  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1264  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1265  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1266  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1267  *	frame headers.
1268  */
1269 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1270 	u32 min_interval;
1271 	u32 max_interval;
1272 	size_t tmpl_len;
1273 	const u8 *tmpl;
1274 };
1275 
1276 /**
1277  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1278  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1279  *
1280  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1281  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1282  *	scanning
1283  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1284  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1285  */
1286 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1287 	u32 interval;
1288 	size_t tmpl_len;
1289 	const u8 *tmpl;
1290 };
1291 
1292 /**
1293  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1294  *
1295  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1296  *
1297  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1298  * @beacon: beacon data
1299  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1300  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1301  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1302  *	user space)
1303  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1304  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1305  * @crypto: crypto settings
1306  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1307  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1308  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1309  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1310  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1311  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1312  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1313  *	MAC address based access control
1314  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1315  *	networks.
1316  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1317  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1318  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1319  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1320  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1321  * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1322  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1323  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1324  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1325  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1326  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1327  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1328  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1329  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1330  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1331  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1332  * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1333  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1334  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1335  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1336  */
1337 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1338 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1339 
1340 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1341 
1342 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1343 	const u8 *ssid;
1344 	size_t ssid_len;
1345 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1346 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1347 	bool privacy;
1348 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1349 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1350 	int inactivity_timeout;
1351 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1352 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1353 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1354 	bool pbss;
1355 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1356 
1357 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1358 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1359 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1360 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1361 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1362 	const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1363 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1364 	bool twt_responder;
1365 	u32 flags;
1366 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1367 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1368 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1369 	struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1370 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1371 
1372 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1373 };
1374 
1375 /**
1376  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1377  *
1378  * Used for channel switch
1379  *
1380  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1381  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1382  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1383  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1384  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1385  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1386  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1387  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1388  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1389  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1390  * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1391  *	a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1392  *	Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1393  */
1394 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1395 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1396 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1397 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1398 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1399 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1400 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1401 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1402 	bool radar_required;
1403 	bool block_tx;
1404 	u8 count;
1405 	u16 punct_bitmap;
1406 
1407 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1408 };
1409 
1410 /**
1411  * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1412  *
1413  * Used for bss color change
1414  *
1415  * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1416  * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1417  * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1418  * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1419  * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1420  * @color: the color used after the change
1421  */
1422 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1423 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1424 	u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1425 	u16 counter_offset_presp;
1426 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1427 	u8 count;
1428 	u8 color;
1429 };
1430 
1431 /**
1432  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1433  *
1434  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1435  *
1436  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1437  *	to use for verification
1438  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1439  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1440  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1441  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1442  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1443  *	nl80211_iftype.
1444  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1445  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1446  *	the verification
1447  */
1448 struct iface_combination_params {
1449 	int num_different_channels;
1450 	u8 radar_detect;
1451 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1452 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1453 };
1454 
1455 /**
1456  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1457  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1458  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1459  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1460  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER: apply tx power for STA
1461  *
1462  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1463  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1464  */
1465 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1466 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1467 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1468 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1469 };
1470 
1471 /**
1472  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1473  *
1474  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1475  *
1476  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1477  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1478  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1479  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1480  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1481  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1482  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1483  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1484  *	per peer TPC.
1485  */
1486 struct sta_txpwr {
1487 	s16 power;
1488 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1489 };
1490 
1491 /**
1492  * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1493  *
1494  * Used to change and create a new link station.
1495  *
1496  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1497  * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1498  * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1499  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1500  *	(or NULL for no change)
1501  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1502  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1503  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1504  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1505  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1506  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1507  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1508  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1509  * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1510  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1511  * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1512  * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1513  */
1514 struct link_station_parameters {
1515 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1516 	int link_id;
1517 	const u8 *link_mac;
1518 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1519 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1520 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1521 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1522 	u8 opmode_notif;
1523 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1524 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1525 	u8 he_capa_len;
1526 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1527 	bool txpwr_set;
1528 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1529 	const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1530 	u8 eht_capa_len;
1531 
1532 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1533 };
1534 
1535 /**
1536  * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1537  *
1538  * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1539  *
1540  * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1541  * @link_id: the link id
1542  */
1543 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1544 	const u8 *mld_mac;
1545 	u32 link_id;
1546 };
1547 
1548 /**
1549  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1550  *
1551  * Used to change and create a new station.
1552  *
1553  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1554  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1555  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1556  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1557  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1558  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1559  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1560  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1561  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1562  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1563  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1564  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1565  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1566  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1567  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1568  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1569  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1570  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1571  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1572  *	to unknown)
1573  * @capability: station capability
1574  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1575  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1576  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1577  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1578  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1579  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1580  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1581  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1582  * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1583  */
1584 struct station_parameters {
1585 	struct net_device *vlan;
1586 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1587 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1588 	int listen_interval;
1589 	u16 aid;
1590 	u16 vlan_id;
1591 	u16 peer_aid;
1592 	u8 plink_action;
1593 	u8 plink_state;
1594 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1595 	u8 max_sp;
1596 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1597 	u16 capability;
1598 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1599 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1600 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1601 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1602 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1603 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1604 	int support_p2p_ps;
1605 	u16 airtime_weight;
1606 	struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1607 };
1608 
1609 /**
1610  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1611  *
1612  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1613  *
1614  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1615  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1616  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1617  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1618  */
1619 struct station_del_parameters {
1620 	const u8 *mac;
1621 	u8 subtype;
1622 	u16 reason_code;
1623 };
1624 
1625 /**
1626  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1627  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1628  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1629  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1630  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1631  *	the AP MLME in the device
1632  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1633  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1634  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1635  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1636  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1637  *	supported/used)
1638  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1639  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1640  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1641  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1642  */
1643 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1644 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1645 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1646 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1647 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1648 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1649 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1650 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1651 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1652 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1653 };
1654 
1655 /**
1656  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1657  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1658  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1659  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1660  *
1661  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1662  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1663  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1664  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1665  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1666  */
1667 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1668 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1669 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1670 
1671 /**
1672  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1673  *
1674  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1675  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1676  *
1677  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1678  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1679  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1680  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1681  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1682  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1683  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1684  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1685  */
1686 enum rate_info_flags {
1687 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1688 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1689 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1690 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1691 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1692 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1693 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1694 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS			= BIT(7),
1695 };
1696 
1697 /**
1698  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1699  *
1700  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1701  *
1702  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1703  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1704  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1705  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1706  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1707  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1708  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1709  * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1710  * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1711  */
1712 enum rate_info_bw {
1713 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1714 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1715 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1716 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1717 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1718 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1719 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1720 	RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1721 	RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1722 };
1723 
1724 /**
1725  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1726  *
1727  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1728  *
1729  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1730  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1731  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1732  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1733  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1734  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1735  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1736  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1737  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1738  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1739  * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1740  * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1741  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1742  */
1743 struct rate_info {
1744 	u8 flags;
1745 	u8 mcs;
1746 	u16 legacy;
1747 	u8 nss;
1748 	u8 bw;
1749 	u8 he_gi;
1750 	u8 he_dcm;
1751 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1752 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1753 	u8 eht_gi;
1754 	u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1755 };
1756 
1757 /**
1758  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1759  *
1760  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1761  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1762  *
1763  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1764  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1765  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1766  */
1767 enum bss_param_flags {
1768 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1769 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1770 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1771 };
1772 
1773 /**
1774  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1775  *
1776  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1777  *
1778  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1779  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1780  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1781  */
1782 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1783 	u8 flags;
1784 	u8 dtim_period;
1785 	u16 beacon_interval;
1786 };
1787 
1788 /**
1789  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1790  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1791  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1792  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1793  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1794  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1795  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1796  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1797  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1798  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1799  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1800  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1801  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1802  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1803  */
1804 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1805 	u32 filled;
1806 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1807 	u32 backlog_packets;
1808 	u32 flows;
1809 	u32 drops;
1810 	u32 ecn_marks;
1811 	u32 overlimit;
1812 	u32 overmemory;
1813 	u32 collisions;
1814 	u32 tx_bytes;
1815 	u32 tx_packets;
1816 	u32 max_flows;
1817 };
1818 
1819 /**
1820  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1821  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1822  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1823  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1824  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1825  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1826  *	transmitted MSDUs
1827  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1828  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1829  */
1830 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1831 	u32 filled;
1832 	u64 rx_msdu;
1833 	u64 tx_msdu;
1834 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1835 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1836 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1837 };
1838 
1839 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1840 
1841 /**
1842  * struct station_info - station information
1843  *
1844  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1845  *
1846  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1847  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1848  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1849  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1850  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1851  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1852  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1853  * @llid: mesh local link id
1854  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1855  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1856  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1857  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1858  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1859  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1860  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1861  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1862  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1863  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1864  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1865  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1866  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1867  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1868  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1869  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1870  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1871  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1872  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1873  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1874  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1875  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1876  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1877  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1878  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1879  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1880  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1881  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1882  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1883  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1884  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1885  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1886  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1887  *	towards this station.
1888  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1889  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1890  *	from this peer
1891  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1892  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1893  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1894  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1895  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1896  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1897  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1898  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1899  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1900  *	been sent.
1901  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1902  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1903  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1904  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1905  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1906  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1907  * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
1908  *	by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
1909  *	MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
1910  *	information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
1911  *	dump_station() callbacks.
1912  * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
1913  *	completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
1914  *	and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
1915  * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
1916  *	For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
1917  * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
1918  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
1919  *	space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
1920  *	cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
1921  *	fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
1922  *	dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
1923  *	the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
1924  * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
1925  */
1926 struct station_info {
1927 	u64 filled;
1928 	u32 connected_time;
1929 	u32 inactive_time;
1930 	u64 assoc_at;
1931 	u64 rx_bytes;
1932 	u64 tx_bytes;
1933 	u16 llid;
1934 	u16 plid;
1935 	u8 plink_state;
1936 	s8 signal;
1937 	s8 signal_avg;
1938 
1939 	u8 chains;
1940 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1941 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1942 
1943 	struct rate_info txrate;
1944 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1945 	u32 rx_packets;
1946 	u32 tx_packets;
1947 	u32 tx_retries;
1948 	u32 tx_failed;
1949 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1950 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1951 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1952 
1953 	int generation;
1954 
1955 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1956 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1957 
1958 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1959 	s64 t_offset;
1960 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1961 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1962 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1963 
1964 	u32 expected_throughput;
1965 
1966 	u64 tx_duration;
1967 	u64 rx_duration;
1968 	u64 rx_beacon;
1969 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1970 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1971 
1972 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1973 	s8 ack_signal;
1974 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1975 
1976 	u16 airtime_weight;
1977 
1978 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1979 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1980 
1981 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1982 
1983 	u8 connected_to_as;
1984 
1985 	bool mlo_params_valid;
1986 	u8 assoc_link_id;
1987 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1988 	const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
1989 	size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
1990 
1991 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1992 };
1993 
1994 /**
1995  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
1996  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
1997  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
1998  */
1999 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2000 	s32 power;
2001 	u32 freq_range_index;
2002 };
2003 
2004 /**
2005  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2006  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2007  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2008  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2009  */
2010 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2011 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2012 	u32 num_sub_specs;
2013 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2014 };
2015 
2016 
2017 /**
2018  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2019  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
2020  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
2021  */
2022 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2023 	u32 start_freq;
2024 	u32 end_freq;
2025 };
2026 
2027 /**
2028  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2029  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2030  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2031  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2032  *
2033  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2034  * range to small ones and then append them.
2035  */
2036 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2037 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2038 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
2039 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2040 };
2041 
2042 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2043 /**
2044  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2045  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2046  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2047  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2048  *
2049  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2050  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2051  * considered undefined.
2052  */
2053 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2054 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
2055 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2056 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2057 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
2058 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
2059 {
2060 	return -ENOENT;
2061 }
2062 #endif
2063 
2064 /**
2065  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2066  *
2067  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2068  * according to the nl80211 flags.
2069  *
2070  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2071  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2072  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2073  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2074  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2075  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2076  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2077  */
2078 enum monitor_flags {
2079 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2080 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2081 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2082 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2083 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2084 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2085 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2086 };
2087 
2088 /**
2089  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
2090  *
2091  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2092  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2093  *
2094  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2095  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2096  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2097  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2098  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2099  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2100  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2101  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2102  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2103  */
2104 enum mpath_info_flags {
2105 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
2106 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
2107 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
2108 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
2109 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
2110 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
2111 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
2112 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
2113 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
2114 };
2115 
2116 /**
2117  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2118  *
2119  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2120  *
2121  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2122  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2123  * @sn: target sequence number
2124  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2125  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2126  * @flags: mesh path flags
2127  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2128  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2129  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2130  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2131  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2132  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2133  * @hop_count: hops to destination
2134  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2135  */
2136 struct mpath_info {
2137 	u32 filled;
2138 	u32 frame_qlen;
2139 	u32 sn;
2140 	u32 metric;
2141 	u32 exptime;
2142 	u32 discovery_timeout;
2143 	u8 discovery_retries;
2144 	u8 flags;
2145 	u8 hop_count;
2146 	u32 path_change_count;
2147 
2148 	int generation;
2149 };
2150 
2151 /**
2152  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2153  *
2154  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2155  *
2156  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2157  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2158  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2159  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2160  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2161  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2162  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2163  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2164  *	(or NULL for no change)
2165  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2166  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2167  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2168  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2169  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2170  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2171  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2172  */
2173 struct bss_parameters {
2174 	int link_id;
2175 	int use_cts_prot;
2176 	int use_short_preamble;
2177 	int use_short_slot_time;
2178 	const u8 *basic_rates;
2179 	u8 basic_rates_len;
2180 	int ap_isolate;
2181 	int ht_opmode;
2182 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2183 };
2184 
2185 /**
2186  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2187  *
2188  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2189  *
2190  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2191  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
2192  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2193  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2194  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2195  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2196  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2197  *	mesh interface
2198  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2199  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2200  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2201  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2202  *	elements
2203  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2204  *	detect compatible mesh peers
2205  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2206  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2207  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2208  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2209  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2210  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2211  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
2212  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2213  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2214  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2215  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2216  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2217  *	element
2218  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2219  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2220  *	element
2221  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2222  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2223  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2224  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2225  *	announcements are transmitted
2226  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2227  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2228  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2229  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2230  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2231  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2232  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2233  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2234  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2235  *	station to establish a peer link
2236  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2237  *
2238  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2239  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2240  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
2241  *
2242  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2243  *	PREQs are transmitted.
2244  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2245  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2246  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2247  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2248  *	setting for new peer links.
2249  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2250  *	after transmitting its beacon.
2251  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2252  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2253  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2254  * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2255  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2256  *	in the mesh formation field.
2257  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2258  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2259  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2260  *      in the mesh path table
2261  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2262  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2263  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2264  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2265  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2266  */
2267 struct mesh_config {
2268 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2269 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2270 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2271 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2272 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2273 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2274 	u8 element_ttl;
2275 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2276 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2277 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2278 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2279 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2280 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2281 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2282 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2283 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2284 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2285 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2286 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2287 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2288 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2289 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2290 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2291 	u16 ht_opmode;
2292 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2293 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2294 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2295 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2296 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2297 	u32 plink_timeout;
2298 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2299 
2300 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2301 };
2302 
2303 /**
2304  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2305  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2306  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2307  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2308  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2309  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2310  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2311  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2312  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2313  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2314  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2315  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2316  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2317  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2318  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2319  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2320  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2321  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2322  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2323  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2324  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2325  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2326  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2327  *
2328  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2329  */
2330 struct mesh_setup {
2331 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2332 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2333 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2334 	u8 sync_method;
2335 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2336 	u8 path_metric;
2337 	u8 auth_id;
2338 	const u8 *ie;
2339 	u8 ie_len;
2340 	bool is_authenticated;
2341 	bool is_secure;
2342 	bool user_mpm;
2343 	u8 dtim_period;
2344 	u16 beacon_interval;
2345 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2346 	u32 basic_rates;
2347 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2348 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2349 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2350 
2351 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2352 };
2353 
2354 /**
2355  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2356  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2357  *
2358  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2359  */
2360 struct ocb_setup {
2361 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2362 };
2363 
2364 /**
2365  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2366  * @ac: AC identifier
2367  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2368  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2369  *	1..32767]
2370  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2371  *	1..32767]
2372  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2373  * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2374  */
2375 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2376 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2377 	u16 txop;
2378 	u16 cwmin;
2379 	u16 cwmax;
2380 	u8 aifs;
2381 	int link_id;
2382 };
2383 
2384 /**
2385  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2386  *
2387  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2388  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2389  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2390  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2391  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2392  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2393  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2394  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2395  * in the wiphy structure.
2396  *
2397  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2398  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2399  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2400  *
2401  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2402  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2403  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2404  * to userspace.
2405  */
2406 
2407 /**
2408  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2409  * @ssid: the SSID
2410  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2411  */
2412 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2413 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2414 	u8 ssid_len;
2415 };
2416 
2417 /**
2418  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2419  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2420  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2421  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2422  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2423  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2424  *	userspace will be notified of that
2425  */
2426 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2427 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2428 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2429 	bool aborted;
2430 };
2431 
2432 /**
2433  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2434  *
2435  * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2436  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2437  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2438  *	 which the above info relvant to
2439  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2440  * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2441  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2442  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2443  */
2444 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2445 	u32 short_ssid;
2446 	u32 channel_idx;
2447 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2448 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2449 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2450 	bool psc_no_listen;
2451 };
2452 
2453 /**
2454  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2455  *
2456  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2457  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2458  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2459  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2460  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2461  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2462  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2463  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2464  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2465  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2466  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2467  *	%duration field.
2468  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2469  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2470  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2471  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2472  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2473  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2474  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2475  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2476  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2477  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2478  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2479  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2480  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2481  *	true if this is the second scan request
2482  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2483  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2484  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2485  */
2486 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2487 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2488 	int n_ssids;
2489 	u32 n_channels;
2490 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2491 	const u8 *ie;
2492 	size_t ie_len;
2493 	u16 duration;
2494 	bool duration_mandatory;
2495 	u32 flags;
2496 
2497 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2498 
2499 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2500 
2501 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2502 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2503 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2504 
2505 	/* internal */
2506 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2507 	unsigned long scan_start;
2508 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2509 	bool notified;
2510 	bool no_cck;
2511 	bool scan_6ghz;
2512 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2513 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2514 
2515 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2516 
2517 	/* keep last */
2518 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2519 };
2520 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2521 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2522 {
2523 	int i;
2524 
2525 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2526 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2527 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2528 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2529 	}
2530 }
2531 
2532 /**
2533  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2534  *
2535  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2536  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2537  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2538  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2539  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2540  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2541  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2542  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2543  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2544  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2545  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2546  *	corresponding matchset.
2547  */
2548 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2549 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2550 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2551 	s32 rssi_thold;
2552 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2553 };
2554 
2555 /**
2556  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2557  *
2558  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2559  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2560  *	infinite loop.
2561  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2562  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2563  */
2564 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2565 	u32 interval;
2566 	u32 iterations;
2567 };
2568 
2569 /**
2570  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2571  *
2572  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2573  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2574  */
2575 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2576 	enum nl80211_band band;
2577 	s8 delta;
2578 };
2579 
2580 /**
2581  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2582  *
2583  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2584  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2585  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2586  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2587  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2588  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2589  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2590  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2591  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2592  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2593  *	(others are filtered out).
2594  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2595  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2596  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2597  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2598  * @dev: the interface
2599  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2600  * @channels: channels to scan
2601  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2602  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2603  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2604  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2605  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2606  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2607  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2608  *	index must be executed first.
2609  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2610  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2611  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2612  *	owned by a particular socket)
2613  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2614  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2615  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2616  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2617  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2618  *	supported.
2619  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2620  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2621  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2622  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2623  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2624  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2625  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2626  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2627  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2628  *	comparisions.
2629  */
2630 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2631 	u64 reqid;
2632 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2633 	int n_ssids;
2634 	u32 n_channels;
2635 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2636 	const u8 *ie;
2637 	size_t ie_len;
2638 	u32 flags;
2639 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2640 	int n_match_sets;
2641 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2642 	u32 delay;
2643 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2644 	int n_scan_plans;
2645 
2646 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2647 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2648 
2649 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2650 	s8 relative_rssi;
2651 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2652 
2653 	/* internal */
2654 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2655 	struct net_device *dev;
2656 	unsigned long scan_start;
2657 	bool report_results;
2658 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2659 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2660 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2661 	struct list_head list;
2662 
2663 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2664 
2665 	/* keep last */
2666 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2667 };
2668 
2669 /**
2670  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2671  *
2672  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2673  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2674  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2675  */
2676 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2677 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2678 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2679 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2680 };
2681 
2682 /**
2683  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2684  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2685  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2686  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2687  *	signal type
2688  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2689  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2690  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2691  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2692  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2693  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2694  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2695  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2696  *	by %parent_bssid.
2697  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2698  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2699  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2700  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2701  */
2702 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2703 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2704 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2705 	s32 signal;
2706 	u64 boottime_ns;
2707 	u64 parent_tsf;
2708 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2709 	u8 chains;
2710 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2711 };
2712 
2713 /**
2714  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2715  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2716  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2717  * @len: length of the IEs
2718  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2719  * @data: IE data
2720  */
2721 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2722 	u64 tsf;
2723 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2724 	int len;
2725 	bool from_beacon;
2726 	u8 data[];
2727 };
2728 
2729 /**
2730  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2731  *
2732  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2733  * for use in scan results and similar.
2734  *
2735  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2736  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2737  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2738  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2739  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2740  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2741  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2742  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2743  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2744  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2745  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2746  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2747  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2748  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2749  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2750  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2751  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2752  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2753  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2754  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2755  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2756  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2757  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2758  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2759  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2760  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2761  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2762  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2763  */
2764 struct cfg80211_bss {
2765 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2766 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2767 
2768 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2769 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2770 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2771 
2772 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2773 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2774 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2775 
2776 	s32 signal;
2777 
2778 	u16 beacon_interval;
2779 	u16 capability;
2780 
2781 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2782 	u8 chains;
2783 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2784 
2785 	u8 bssid_index;
2786 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2787 
2788 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2789 
2790 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2791 };
2792 
2793 /**
2794  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2795  * @bss: the bss to search
2796  * @id: the element ID
2797  *
2798  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2799  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2800  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2801  */
2802 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2803 
2804 /**
2805  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2806  * @bss: the bss to search
2807  * @id: the element ID
2808  *
2809  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2810  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2811  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2812  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)2813 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2814 {
2815 	return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2816 }
2817 
2818 
2819 /**
2820  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2821  *
2822  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2823  * authentication.
2824  *
2825  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2826  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2827  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2828  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2829  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2830  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2831  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2832  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2833  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2834  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2835  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2836  *	transaction sequence number field.
2837  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2838  * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
2839  *	the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
2840  *	necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
2841  *	given an MLD address) by the driver
2842  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
2843  *	an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
2844  */
2845 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2846 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2847 	const u8 *ie;
2848 	size_t ie_len;
2849 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2850 	const u8 *key;
2851 	u8 key_len;
2852 	s8 key_idx;
2853 	const u8 *auth_data;
2854 	size_t auth_data_len;
2855 	s8 link_id;
2856 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
2857 };
2858 
2859 /**
2860  * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
2861  * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
2862  *	if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
2863  * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
2864  * @elems_len: length of the elements
2865  */
2866 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
2867 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2868 	const u8 *elems;
2869 	size_t elems_len;
2870 };
2871 
2872 /**
2873  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2874  *
2875  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2876  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2877  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2878  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2879  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2880  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2881  *	request (connect callback).
2882  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
2883  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT:  Disable EHT
2884  * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
2885  *	Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
2886  *	flag is not set.
2887  */
2888 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2889 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2890 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2891 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2892 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2893 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
2894 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT			= BIT(5),
2895 	CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT			= BIT(6),
2896 };
2897 
2898 /**
2899  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2900  *
2901  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2902  * (re)association.
2903  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2904  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2905  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2906  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2907  *	This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
2908  *	of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
2909  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2910  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2911  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2912  * @crypto: crypto settings
2913  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2914  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2915  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2916  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2917  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2918  *	frame.
2919  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2920  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2921  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2922  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2923  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2924  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2925  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2926  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2927  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2928  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2929  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2930  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2931  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2932  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2933  * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
2934  * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
2935  *	the link on which the association request should be sent
2936  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
2937  *	valid iff @link_id >= 0
2938  */
2939 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2940 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2941 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2942 	size_t ie_len;
2943 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2944 	bool use_mfp;
2945 	u32 flags;
2946 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2947 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2948 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2949 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2950 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2951 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2952 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2953 	struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2954 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
2955 	s8 link_id;
2956 
2957 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2958 };
2959 
2960 /**
2961  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2962  *
2963  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2964  * deauthentication.
2965  *
2966  * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
2967  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2968  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2969  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2970  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2971  *	do not set a deauth frame
2972  */
2973 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2974 	const u8 *bssid;
2975 	const u8 *ie;
2976 	size_t ie_len;
2977 	u16 reason_code;
2978 	bool local_state_change;
2979 };
2980 
2981 /**
2982  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2983  *
2984  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2985  * disassociation.
2986  *
2987  * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
2988  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2989  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2990  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2991  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2992  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2993  */
2994 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2995 	const u8 *ap_addr;
2996 	const u8 *ie;
2997 	size_t ie_len;
2998 	u16 reason_code;
2999 	bool local_state_change;
3000 };
3001 
3002 /**
3003  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3004  *
3005  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3006  * method.
3007  *
3008  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3009  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3010  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3011  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3012  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3013  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3014  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
3015  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3016  * @ie_len: length of that
3017  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3018  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3019  *	after joining
3020  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3021  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3022  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3023  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3024  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3025  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3026  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3027  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3028  *	to operate on DFS channels.
3029  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3030  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3031  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3032  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3033  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3034  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3035  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3036  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3037  */
3038 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3039 	const u8 *ssid;
3040 	const u8 *bssid;
3041 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3042 	const u8 *ie;
3043 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3044 	u16 beacon_interval;
3045 	u32 basic_rates;
3046 	bool channel_fixed;
3047 	bool privacy;
3048 	bool control_port;
3049 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3050 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3051 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3052 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3053 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3054 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
3055 	int wep_tx_key;
3056 
3057 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3058 };
3059 
3060 /**
3061  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3062  *
3063  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3064  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3065  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3066  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3067  */
3068 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3069 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3070 	union {
3071 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3072 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3073 	} param;
3074 };
3075 
3076 /**
3077  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3078  *
3079  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3080  * authentication and association.
3081  *
3082  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3083  *	on scan results)
3084  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3085  *	%NULL if not specified
3086  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3087  *	results)
3088  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3089  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3090  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3091  *	to use.
3092  * @ssid: SSID
3093  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3094  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3095  * @ie: IEs for association request
3096  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3097  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3098  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3099  * @crypto: crypto settings
3100  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3101  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3102  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3103  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3104  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
3105  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3106  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
3107  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
3108  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3109  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
3110  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3111  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3112  *	networks.
3113  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3114  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3115  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3116  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3117  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3118  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3119  *	frame.
3120  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3121  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3122  *	data IE.
3123  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3124  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3125  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3126  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3127  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3128  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3129  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3130  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3131  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3132  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3133  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3134  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
3135  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3136  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3137  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3138  */
3139 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3140 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3141 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3142 	const u8 *bssid;
3143 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
3144 	const u8 *ssid;
3145 	size_t ssid_len;
3146 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3147 	const u8 *ie;
3148 	size_t ie_len;
3149 	bool privacy;
3150 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3151 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3152 	const u8 *key;
3153 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
3154 	u32 flags;
3155 	int bg_scan_period;
3156 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3157 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3158 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3159 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3160 	bool pbss;
3161 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3162 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
3163 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3164 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3165 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3166 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3167 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3168 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3169 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3170 	bool want_1x;
3171 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3172 
3173 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3174 };
3175 
3176 /**
3177  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3178  *
3179  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3180  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3181  *
3182  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3183  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3184  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3185  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3186  */
3187 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3188 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
3189 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
3190 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
3191 };
3192 
3193 /**
3194  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3195  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3196  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3197  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3198  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3199  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3200  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3201  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3202  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3203  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3204  */
3205 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3206 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
3207 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
3208 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
3209 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
3210 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
3211 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
3212 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
3213 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
3214 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
3215 };
3216 
3217 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
3218 
3219 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3220 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
3221 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
3222 
3223 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3224 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
3225 
3226 /**
3227  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3228  *
3229  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3230  * caching.
3231  *
3232  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3233  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3234  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3235  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3236  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3237  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3238  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3239  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3240  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3241  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3242  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3243  *	%NULL).
3244  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3245  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3246  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3247  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3248  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3249  *	used for it expires.
3250  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3251  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3252  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3253  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3254  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3255  */
3256 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3257 	const u8 *bssid;
3258 	const u8 *pmkid;
3259 	const u8 *pmk;
3260 	size_t pmk_len;
3261 	const u8 *ssid;
3262 	size_t ssid_len;
3263 	const u8 *cache_id;
3264 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
3265 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3266 };
3267 
3268 /**
3269  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3270  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3271  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3272  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3273  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3274  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3275  *
3276  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3277  * memory, free @mask only!
3278  */
3279 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3280 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3281 	int pattern_len;
3282 	int pkt_offset;
3283 };
3284 
3285 /**
3286  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3287  *
3288  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3289  * @src: source IP address
3290  * @dst: destination IP address
3291  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3292  * @src_port: source port
3293  * @dst_port: destination port
3294  * @payload_len: data payload length
3295  * @payload: data payload buffer
3296  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3297  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3298  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3299  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3300  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3301  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3302  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3303  */
3304 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3305 	struct socket *sock;
3306 	__be32 src, dst;
3307 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
3308 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3309 	int payload_len;
3310 	const u8 *payload;
3311 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3312 	u32 data_interval;
3313 	u32 wake_len;
3314 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3315 	u32 tokens_size;
3316 	/* must be last, variable member */
3317 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3318 };
3319 
3320 /**
3321  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3322  *
3323  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3324  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3325  *	operating as normal during suspend
3326  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3327  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3328  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3329  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3330  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3331  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3332  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3333  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3334  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3335  *	NULL if not configured.
3336  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3337  */
3338 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3339 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3340 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3341 	     rfkill_release;
3342 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3343 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3344 	int n_patterns;
3345 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3346 };
3347 
3348 /**
3349  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3350  *
3351  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3352  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3353  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3354  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3355  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3356  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3357  */
3358 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3359 	int delay;
3360 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3361 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3362 	int n_patterns;
3363 };
3364 
3365 /**
3366  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3367  *
3368  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3369  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3370  * @n_rules: number of rules
3371  */
3372 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3373 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3374 	int n_rules;
3375 };
3376 
3377 /**
3378  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3379  *
3380  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3381  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3382  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3383  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3384  *	occurred (in MHz)
3385  */
3386 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3387 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3388 	int n_channels;
3389 	u32 channels[];
3390 };
3391 
3392 /**
3393  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3394  *
3395  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3396  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3397  *	match information.
3398  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3399  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3400  */
3401 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3402 	int n_matches;
3403 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3404 };
3405 
3406 /**
3407  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3408  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3409  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3410  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3411  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3412  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3413  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3414  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3415  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3416  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3417  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3418  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3419  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3420  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3421  *	it is.
3422  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3423  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3424  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3425  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3426  */
3427 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3428 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3429 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3430 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3431 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3432 	s32 pattern_idx;
3433 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3434 	const void *packet;
3435 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3436 };
3437 
3438 /**
3439  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3440  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3441  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3442  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3443  * @kek_len: length of kek
3444  * @kck_len: length of kck
3445  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3446  */
3447 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3448 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3449 	u32 akm;
3450 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3451 };
3452 
3453 /**
3454  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3455  *
3456  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3457  *
3458  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3459  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3460  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3461  */
3462 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3463 	u16 md;
3464 	const u8 *ie;
3465 	size_t ie_len;
3466 };
3467 
3468 /**
3469  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3470  *
3471  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3472  *
3473  * @chan: channel to use
3474  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3475  * @wait: duration for ROC
3476  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3477  * @len: buffer length
3478  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3479  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3480  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3481  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3482  * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3483  *	that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3484  *	link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3485  */
3486 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3487 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3488 	bool offchan;
3489 	unsigned int wait;
3490 	const u8 *buf;
3491 	size_t len;
3492 	bool no_cck;
3493 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3494 	int n_csa_offsets;
3495 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3496 	int link_id;
3497 };
3498 
3499 /**
3500  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3501  *
3502  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3503  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3504  */
3505 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3506 	u8 dscp;
3507 	u8 up;
3508 };
3509 
3510 /**
3511  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3512  *
3513  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3514  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3515  */
3516 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3517 	u8 low;
3518 	u8 high;
3519 };
3520 
3521 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3522 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3523 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3524 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3525 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3526 
3527 /**
3528  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3529  *
3530  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3531  *
3532  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3533  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3534  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3535  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3536  */
3537 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3538 	u8 num_des;
3539 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3540 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3541 };
3542 
3543 /**
3544  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3545  *
3546  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3547  *
3548  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3549  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3550  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3551  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3552  */
3553 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3554 	u8 master_pref;
3555 	u8 bands;
3556 };
3557 
3558 /**
3559  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3560  * configuration
3561  *
3562  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3563  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3564  */
3565 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3566 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3567 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3568 };
3569 
3570 /**
3571  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3572  *
3573  * @filter: the content of the filter
3574  * @len: the length of the filter
3575  */
3576 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3577 	const u8 *filter;
3578 	u8 len;
3579 };
3580 
3581 /**
3582  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3583  *
3584  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3585  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3586  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3587  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3588  *	implementation specific.
3589  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3590  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3591  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3592  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3593  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3594  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3595  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3596  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3597  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3598  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3599  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3600  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3601  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3602  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3603  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3604  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3605  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3606  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3607  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3608  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3609  */
3610 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3611 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3612 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3613 	u8 publish_type;
3614 	bool close_range;
3615 	bool publish_bcast;
3616 	bool subscribe_active;
3617 	u8 followup_id;
3618 	u8 followup_reqid;
3619 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3620 	u32 ttl;
3621 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3622 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3623 	bool srf_include;
3624 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3625 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3626 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3627 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3628 	int srf_num_macs;
3629 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3630 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3631 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3632 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3633 	u8 instance_id;
3634 	u64 cookie;
3635 
3636 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3637 };
3638 
3639 /**
3640  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3641  *
3642  * @aa: authenticator address
3643  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3644  * @pmk: the PMK material
3645  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3646  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3647  *	holds PMK-R0.
3648  */
3649 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3650 	const u8 *aa;
3651 	u8 pmk_len;
3652 	const u8 *pmk;
3653 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3654 };
3655 
3656 /**
3657  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3658  *
3659  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3660  *
3661  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3662  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3663  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3664  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3665  *	authentication response command interface.
3666  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3667  *	authentication response command interface.
3668  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3669  *	authentication request event interface.
3670  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3671  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3672  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3673  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3674  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3675  * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3676  *	interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3677  *	offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3678  *	flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3679  *	supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3680  *	User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3681  *	authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3682  *	and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3683  *	authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3684  *	translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3685  *	chosen for the authentication.
3686  */
3687 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3688 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3689 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3690 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3691 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3692 	u16 status;
3693 	const u8 *pmkid;
3694 	u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3695 };
3696 
3697 /**
3698  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3699  *
3700  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3701  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3702  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3703  *	answered
3704  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3705  *	successfully answered
3706  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3707  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3708  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3709  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3710  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3711  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3712  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3713  *	the responder
3714  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3715  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3716  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3717  */
3718 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3719 	u32 filled;
3720 	u32 success_num;
3721 	u32 partial_num;
3722 	u32 failed_num;
3723 	u32 asap_num;
3724 	u32 non_asap_num;
3725 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3726 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3727 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3728 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3729 };
3730 
3731 /**
3732  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3733  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3734  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3735  *	reason than just "failure"
3736  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3737  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3738  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3739  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3740  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3741  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3742  *	by the responder
3743  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3744  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3745  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3746  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3747  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3748  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3749  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3750  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3751  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3752  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3753  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3754  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3755  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3756  *	the square root of the variance)
3757  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3758  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3759  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3760  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3761  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3762  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3763  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3764  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3765  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3766  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3767  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3768  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3769  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3770  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3771  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3772  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3773  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3774  */
3775 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3776 	const u8 *lci;
3777 	const u8 *civicloc;
3778 	unsigned int lci_len;
3779 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3780 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3781 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3782 	s16 burst_index;
3783 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3784 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3785 	u8 burst_duration;
3786 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3787 	s32 rssi_avg;
3788 	s32 rssi_spread;
3789 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3790 	s64 rtt_avg;
3791 	s64 rtt_variance;
3792 	s64 rtt_spread;
3793 	s64 dist_avg;
3794 	s64 dist_variance;
3795 	s64 dist_spread;
3796 
3797 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3798 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3799 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3800 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3801 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3802 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3803 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3804 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3805 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3806 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3807 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3808 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3809 
3810 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3811 };
3812 
3813 /**
3814  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3815  * @addr: address of the peer
3816  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3817  *	measurement was made)
3818  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3819  * @status: status of the measurement
3820  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3821  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3822  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3823  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3824  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3825  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3826  * @ftm: FTM result
3827  */
3828 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3829 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3830 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3831 
3832 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3833 
3834 	u8 final:1,
3835 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3836 
3837 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3838 
3839 	union {
3840 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3841 	};
3842 };
3843 
3844 /**
3845  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3846  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3847  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3848  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3849  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3850  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3851  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3852  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3853  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3854  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3855  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3856  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3857  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3858  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3859  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3860  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3861  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3862  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3863  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3864  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3865  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3866  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3867  *
3868  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3869  */
3870 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3871 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3872 	u16 burst_period;
3873 	u8 requested:1,
3874 	   asap:1,
3875 	   request_lci:1,
3876 	   request_civicloc:1,
3877 	   trigger_based:1,
3878 	   non_trigger_based:1,
3879 	   lmr_feedback:1;
3880 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3881 	u8 burst_duration;
3882 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3883 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3884 	u8 bss_color;
3885 };
3886 
3887 /**
3888  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3889  * @addr: MAC address
3890  * @chandef: channel to use
3891  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3892  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3893  */
3894 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3895 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3896 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3897 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3898 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3899 };
3900 
3901 /**
3902  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3903  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3904  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3905  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3906  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3907  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3908  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3909  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3910  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3911  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3912  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3913  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3914  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3915  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3916  */
3917 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3918 	u64 cookie;
3919 	void *drv_data;
3920 	u32 n_peers;
3921 	u32 nl_portid;
3922 
3923 	u32 timeout;
3924 
3925 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3926 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3927 
3928 	struct list_head list;
3929 
3930 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3931 };
3932 
3933 /**
3934  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3935  *
3936  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3937  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3938  *
3939  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3940  *
3941  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3942  *	has to be done.
3943  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3944  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3945  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3946  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3947  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3948  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3949  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3950  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3951  * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
3952  *	by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
3953  *	connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
3954  *	will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
3955  * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
3956  *	connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
3957  *	@assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
3958  *	with OWE update event (driver to user space).
3959  */
3960 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3961 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3962 	u16 status;
3963 	const u8 *ie;
3964 	size_t ie_len;
3965 	int assoc_link_id;
3966 	u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3967 };
3968 
3969 /**
3970  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3971  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3972  *	for the entire device
3973  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3974  *	for the given interface
3975  * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3976  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3977  *	for these subtypes
3978  */
3979 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3980 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3981 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3982 };
3983 
3984 /**
3985  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3986  *
3987  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3988  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3989  *
3990  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3991  * on success or a negative error code.
3992  *
3993  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
3994  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
3995  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
3996  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
3997  *
3998  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3999  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4000  *	configured for the device.
4001  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4002  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4003  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4004  *	the device.
4005  *
4006  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4007  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4008  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4009  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4010  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
4011  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4012  *
4013  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4014  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4015  *
4016  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4017  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4018  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4019  *
4020  * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4021  *	the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4022  *	address is available.
4023  * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4024  *
4025  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4026  *	when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4027  *	For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4028  *	pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4029  *
4030  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4031  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4032  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4033  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4034  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4035  *	@link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4036  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4037  *	will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4038  *
4039  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4040  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4041  *	be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4042  *	for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4043  *	address for MLO pairwise key.
4044  *
4045  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4046  *	for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4047  *
4048  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4049  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4050  *
4051  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4052  *	@link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4053  *
4054  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4055  *
4056  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4057  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4058  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4059  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4060  *
4061  * @add_station: Add a new station.
4062  * @del_station: Remove a station
4063  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4064  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4065  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4066  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4067  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4068  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4069  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4070  *
4071  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4072  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4073  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4074  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4075  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4076  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4077  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4078  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4079  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4080  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4081  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4082  *
4083  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4084  *
4085  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4086  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4087  *	set, and which to leave alone.
4088  *
4089  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4090  *
4091  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4092  *
4093  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4094  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4095  *	join the mesh instead.
4096  *
4097  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4098  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4099  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4100  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4101  *
4102  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4103  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4104  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4105  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4106  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4107  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4108  *
4109  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4110  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4111  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4112  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4113  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4114  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4115  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4116  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4117  *
4118  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4119  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4120  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4121  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4122  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4123  *	was received.
4124  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4125  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4126  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4127  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4128  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
4129  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4130  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4131  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4132  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
4133  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4134  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4135  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4136  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4137  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4138  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4139  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4140  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4141  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4142  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4143  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4144  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4145  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4146  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
4147  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4148  *
4149  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4150  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4151  *	to a merge.
4152  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4153  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4154  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4155  *
4156  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4157  *	MESH mode)
4158  *
4159  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4160  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4161  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4162  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4163  *
4164  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4165  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4166  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4167  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4168  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4169  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4170  *	return 0 if successful
4171  *
4172  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4173  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4174  *
4175  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4176  *
4177  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4178  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4179  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4180  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4181  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4182  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4183  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4184  *	the duration value.
4185  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4186  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4187  *	frame on another channel
4188  *
4189  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4190  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4191  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4192  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4193  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4194  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4195  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4196  *
4197  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4198  *
4199  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4200  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4201  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4202  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4203  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4204  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4205  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4206  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4207  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4208  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4209  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4210  *	disabled.)
4211  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4212  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
4213  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
4214  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4215  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4216  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4217  *	thresholds.
4218  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4219  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4220  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4221  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4222  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4223  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4224  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
4225  *
4226  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4227  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4228  *
4229  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4230  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4231  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4232  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4233  *
4234  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4235  *
4236  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4237  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4238  *
4239  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4240  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4241  *
4242  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4243  *
4244  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4245  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4246  *	current monitoring channel.
4247  *
4248  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4249  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4250  *
4251  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4252  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4253  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4254  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4255  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4256  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4257  *
4258  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4259  *
4260  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4261  *	was finished on another phy.
4262  *
4263  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4264  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4265  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4266  *
4267  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4268  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4269  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4270  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4271  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
4272  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4273  *
4274  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4275  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4276  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4277  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4278  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4279  *	as soon as possible.
4280  *
4281  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4282  *
4283  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4284  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4285  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4286  *
4287  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4288  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4289  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4290  *	account.
4291  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4292  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4293  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4294  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4295  *	rejected)
4296  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4297  *
4298  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4299  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4300  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4301  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4302  *
4303  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4304  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4305  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4306  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4307  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4308  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4309  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4310  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4311  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4312  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4313  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4314  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4315  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4316  *	provided @nan_func.
4317  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4318  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4319  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4320  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
4321  *
4322  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4323  *
4324  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4325  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4326  *
4327  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4328  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4329  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
4330  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4331  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4332  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4333  *
4334  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4335  *     user space
4336  *
4337  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
4338  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4339  *
4340  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4341  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4342  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4343  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4344  *
4345  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4346  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4347  *	DH IE through this interface.
4348  *
4349  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4350  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4351  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4352  *	This callback may sleep.
4353  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4354  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4355  *
4356  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4357  *
4358  * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4359  *
4360  * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4361  *	those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4362  *	Response frame.
4363  *
4364  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4365  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4366  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4367  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4368  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4369  *	radar channel.
4370  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4371  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4372  * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4373  * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4374  * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4375  */
4376 struct cfg80211_ops {
4377 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4378 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4379 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4380 
4381 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4382 						  const char *name,
4383 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4384 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4385 						  struct vif_params *params);
4386 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4387 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4388 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4389 				       struct net_device *dev,
4390 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4391 				       struct vif_params *params);
4392 
4393 	int	(*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4394 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4395 				 unsigned int link_id);
4396 	void	(*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4397 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4398 				 unsigned int link_id);
4399 
4400 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4401 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4402 			   const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4403 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4404 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4405 			   const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4406 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4407 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4408 			   int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4409 			   const u8 *mac_addr);
4410 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4411 				   struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4412 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4413 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4414 					struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4415 					u8 key_index);
4416 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4417 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4418 					  int link_id,
4419 					  u8 key_index);
4420 
4421 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4422 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4423 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4424 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
4425 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4426 			   unsigned int link_id);
4427 
4428 
4429 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4430 			       const u8 *mac,
4431 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4432 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4433 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4434 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4435 				  const u8 *mac,
4436 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4437 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4438 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4439 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4440 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4441 
4442 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4443 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4444 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4445 			       const u8 *dst);
4446 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4447 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4448 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4449 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4450 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4451 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4452 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4453 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4454 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4455 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4456 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4457 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4458 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4459 				struct net_device *dev,
4460 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4461 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4462 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4463 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4464 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4465 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4466 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4467 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4468 
4469 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4470 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4471 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4472 
4473 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4474 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4475 
4476 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4477 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4478 
4479 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4480 					     struct net_device *dev,
4481 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4482 
4483 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4484 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4485 
4486 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4487 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4488 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4489 
4490 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4491 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4492 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4493 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4494 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4495 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4496 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4497 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4498 
4499 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4500 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4501 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4502 					 struct net_device *dev,
4503 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4504 					 u32 changed);
4505 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4506 			      u16 reason_code);
4507 
4508 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4509 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4510 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4511 
4512 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4513 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4514 
4515 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4516 
4517 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4518 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4519 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4520 				int *dbm);
4521 
4522 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4523 
4524 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4525 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4526 				void *data, int len);
4527 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4528 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4529 				 void *data, int len);
4530 #endif
4531 
4532 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4533 				    struct net_device *dev,
4534 				    unsigned int link_id,
4535 				    const u8 *peer,
4536 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4537 
4538 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4539 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4540 
4541 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4542 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4543 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4544 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4545 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4546 
4547 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4548 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4549 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4550 				     unsigned int duration,
4551 				     u64 *cookie);
4552 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4553 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4554 					    u64 cookie);
4555 
4556 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4557 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4558 			   u64 *cookie);
4559 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4560 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4561 				       u64 cookie);
4562 
4563 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4564 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4565 
4566 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4567 				       struct net_device *dev,
4568 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4569 
4570 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4571 					     struct net_device *dev,
4572 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4573 
4574 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4575 				      struct net_device *dev,
4576 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4577 
4578 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4579 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4580 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4581 
4582 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4583 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4584 
4585 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4586 				struct net_device *dev,
4587 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4588 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4589 				   u64 reqid);
4590 
4591 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4592 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4593 
4594 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4595 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4596 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4597 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4598 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4599 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4600 
4601 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4602 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4603 
4604 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4605 				  struct net_device *dev,
4606 				  u16 noack_map);
4607 
4608 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4609 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4610 			       unsigned int link_id,
4611 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4612 
4613 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4614 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4615 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4616 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4617 
4618 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4619 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4620 
4621 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4622 					 struct net_device *dev,
4623 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4624 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4625 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4626 				struct net_device *dev);
4627 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4628 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4629 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4630 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4631 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4632 				    u16 duration);
4633 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4634 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4635 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4636 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4637 
4638 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4639 				  struct net_device *dev,
4640 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4641 
4642 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4643 			       struct net_device *dev,
4644 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4645 
4646 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4647 				    unsigned int link_id,
4648 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4649 
4650 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4651 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4652 			     u16 admitted_time);
4653 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4654 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4655 
4656 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4657 				       struct net_device *dev,
4658 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4659 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4660 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4661 					      struct net_device *dev,
4662 					      const u8 *addr);
4663 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4664 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4665 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4666 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4667 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4668 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4669 			       u64 cookie);
4670 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4671 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4672 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4673 				   u32 changes);
4674 
4675 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4676 					    struct net_device *dev,
4677 					    const bool enabled);
4678 
4679 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4680 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4681 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4682 
4683 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4684 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4685 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4686 			   const u8 *aa);
4687 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4688 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4689 
4690 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4691 				   struct net_device *dev,
4692 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4693 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4694 				   const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4695 				   u64 *cookie);
4696 
4697 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4698 				struct net_device *dev,
4699 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4700 
4701 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4702 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4703 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4704 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4705 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4706 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4707 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4709 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4710 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4711 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4712 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4713 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4714 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4715 	int	(*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4716 				struct net_device *dev,
4717 				struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4718 	int     (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4719 				struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4720 	int	(*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4721 					struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4722 	int	(*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4723 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4724 	int	(*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4725 				    struct link_station_parameters *params);
4726 	int	(*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4727 				    struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4728 
4729 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4730 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
4731 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
4732 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
4733 };
4734 
4735 /*
4736  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4737  * and registration/helper functions
4738  */
4739 
4740 /**
4741  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4742  *
4743  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4744  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4745  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4746  *	wiphy at all
4747  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4748  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4749  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4750  *	reason to override the default
4751  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4752  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4753  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4754  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4755  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4756  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4757  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4758  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4759  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4760  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4761  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4762  *	firmware.
4763  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4764  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4765  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4766  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4767  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4768  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4769  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4770  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4771  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4772  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4773  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4774  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4775  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4776  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4777  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4778  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4779  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4780  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4781  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4782  *	before connection.
4783  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4784  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4785  *	in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4786  *	complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4787  *	should set this flag for now.
4788  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4789  */
4790 enum wiphy_flags {
4791 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4792 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO			= BIT(1),
4793 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4794 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4795 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4796 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4797 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4798 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4799 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4800 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4801 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32          = BIT(11),
4802 	/* use hole at 12 */
4803 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4804 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4805 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4806 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4807 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4808 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4809 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4810 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4811 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4812 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4813 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4814 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4815 };
4816 
4817 /**
4818  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4819  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4820  * @types: interface types (bits)
4821  */
4822 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4823 	u16 max;
4824 	u16 types;
4825 };
4826 
4827 /**
4828  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4829  *
4830  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4831  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4832  *
4833  * Examples:
4834  *
4835  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4836  *
4837  *    .. code-block:: c
4838  *
4839  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4840  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4841  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4842  *	};
4843  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4844  *		.limits = limits1,
4845  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4846  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4847  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4848  *	};
4849  *
4850  *
4851  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4852  *
4853  *    .. code-block:: c
4854  *
4855  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4856  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4857  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4858  *	};
4859  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4860  *		.limits = limits2,
4861  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4862  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4863  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4864  *	};
4865  *
4866  *
4867  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4868  *
4869  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4870  *
4871  *    .. code-block:: c
4872  *
4873  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4874  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4875  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4876  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4877  *	};
4878  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4879  *		.limits = limits3,
4880  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4881  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4882  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4883  *	};
4884  *
4885  */
4886 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4887 	/**
4888 	 * @limits:
4889 	 * limits for the given interface types
4890 	 */
4891 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4892 
4893 	/**
4894 	 * @num_different_channels:
4895 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4896 	 */
4897 	u32 num_different_channels;
4898 
4899 	/**
4900 	 * @max_interfaces:
4901 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4902 	 */
4903 	u16 max_interfaces;
4904 
4905 	/**
4906 	 * @n_limits:
4907 	 * number of limitations
4908 	 */
4909 	u8 n_limits;
4910 
4911 	/**
4912 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4913 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4914 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4915 	 */
4916 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4917 
4918 	/**
4919 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4920 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4921 	 */
4922 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4923 
4924 	/**
4925 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4926 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4927 	 */
4928 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4929 
4930 	/**
4931 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4932 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4933 	 *
4934 	 * = 0
4935 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4936 	 * > 0
4937 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4938 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4939 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4940 	 */
4941 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4942 };
4943 
4944 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4945 	u16 tx, rx;
4946 };
4947 
4948 /**
4949  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4950  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4951  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4952  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4953  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4954  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4955  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4956  *	(see nl80211.h)
4957  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4958  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4959  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4960  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4961  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4962  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4963  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4964  */
4965 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4966 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4967 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4968 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4969 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4970 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4971 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4972 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4973 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4974 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4975 };
4976 
4977 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4978 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4979 	u32 data_payload_max;
4980 	u32 data_interval_max;
4981 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4982 	bool seq;
4983 };
4984 
4985 /**
4986  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4987  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4988  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4989  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4990  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4991  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4992  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4993  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4994  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4995  *	scheduled scans.
4996  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4997  *	details.
4998  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4999  */
5000 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5001 	u32 flags;
5002 	int n_patterns;
5003 	int pattern_max_len;
5004 	int pattern_min_len;
5005 	int max_pkt_offset;
5006 	int max_nd_match_sets;
5007 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5008 };
5009 
5010 /**
5011  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5012  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5013  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5014  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5015  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5016  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5017  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5018  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5019  */
5020 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5021 	int n_rules;
5022 	int max_delay;
5023 	int n_patterns;
5024 	int pattern_max_len;
5025 	int pattern_min_len;
5026 	int max_pkt_offset;
5027 };
5028 
5029 /**
5030  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5031  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5032  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5033  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5034  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5035  */
5036 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5037 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5038 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5039 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5040 };
5041 
5042 /**
5043  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5044  *
5045  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5046  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5047  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5048  *
5049  */
5050 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5051 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
5052 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
5053 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
5054 };
5055 
5056 /**
5057  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5058  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5059  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5060  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5061  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5062  */
5063 
5064 struct sta_opmode_info {
5065 	u32 changed;
5066 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5067 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5068 	u8 rx_nss;
5069 };
5070 
5071 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5072 
5073 /**
5074  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5075  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5076  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5077  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5078  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5079  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5080  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5081  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5082  *	dumpit calls.
5083  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5084  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5085  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5086  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5087  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5088  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5089  * are used with dump requests.
5090  */
5091 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5092 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5093 	u32 flags;
5094 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5095 		    const void *data, int data_len);
5096 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5097 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5098 		      unsigned long *storage);
5099 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
5100 	unsigned int maxattr;
5101 
5102 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5103 };
5104 
5105 /**
5106  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5107  * @iftype: interface type
5108  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5109  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5110  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5111  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5112  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5113  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5114  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5115  * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5116  * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5117  */
5118 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5119 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5120 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5121 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5122 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5123 	u16 eml_capabilities;
5124 	u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5125 };
5126 
5127 /**
5128  * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5129  * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5130  * @type: the interface type to look up
5131  */
5132 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5133 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5134 
5135 /**
5136  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5137  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5138  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5139  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5140  * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5141  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5142  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5143  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5144  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5145  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5146  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5147  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5148  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5149  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5150  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5151  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5152  *	not limited)
5153  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5154  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5155  */
5156 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5157 	unsigned int max_peers;
5158 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5159 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
5160 
5161 	struct {
5162 		u32 preambles;
5163 		u32 bandwidths;
5164 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5165 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5166 		u8 supported:1,
5167 		   asap:1,
5168 		   non_asap:1,
5169 		   request_lci:1,
5170 		   request_civicloc:1,
5171 		   trigger_based:1,
5172 		   non_trigger_based:1;
5173 	} ftm;
5174 };
5175 
5176 /**
5177  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5178  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5179  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5180  *
5181  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5182  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5183  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5184  */
5185 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5186 	u16 iftypes_mask;
5187 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5188 	int n_akm_suites;
5189 };
5190 
5191 /**
5192  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5193  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5194  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5195  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5196  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5197  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5198  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5199  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5200  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5201  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5202  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5203  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5204  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5205  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5206  *	iftype_akm_suites.
5207  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5208  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5209  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5210  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5211  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5212  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5213  *	suites are specified separately.
5214  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5215  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5216  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5217  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5218  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5219  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5220  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5221  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5222  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5223  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5224  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5225  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5226  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5227  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5228  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5229  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5230  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5231  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5232  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5233  *	unregister hardware
5234  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5235  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5236  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5237  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5238  *	(see below).
5239  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5240  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5241  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5242  *	must be set by driver
5243  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5244  *	list single interface types.
5245  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5246  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5247  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5248  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5249  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5250  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5251  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5252  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5253  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5254  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5255  *	this variable determines its size
5256  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5257  *	any given scan
5258  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5259  *	the device can run concurrently.
5260  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5261  *	for in any given scheduled scan
5262  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5263  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5264  *	supported.
5265  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5266  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5267  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
5268  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5269  *	scans
5270  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5271  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5272  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5273  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
5274  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5275  *	scan plan supported by the device.
5276  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5277  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5278  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5279  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5280  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5281  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5282  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5283  *
5284  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5285  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5286  *	type
5287  *
5288  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5289  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5290  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5291  *
5292  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5293  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5294  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5295  *
5296  * @probe_resp_offload:
5297  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5298  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5299  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5300  *
5301  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5302  *	may request, if implemented.
5303  *
5304  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5305  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5306  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5307  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
5308  *
5309  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5310  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5311  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5312  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5313  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5314  *
5315  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5316  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5317  *
5318  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5319  *	supports for ACL.
5320  *
5321  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5322  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5323  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5324  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5325  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5326  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5327  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5328  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5329  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5330  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5331  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5332  *	capabilities are specified separately.
5333  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5334  *
5335  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5336  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5337  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5338  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5339  *
5340  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5341  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5342  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5343  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
5344  *
5345  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5346  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
5347  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5348  *	infinite.
5349  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5350  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5351  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5352  *
5353  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5354  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
5355  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5356  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5357  *
5358  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5359  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5360  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5361  *
5362  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5363  *	wake_tx_queue
5364  *
5365  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5366  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5367  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5368  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5369  *
5370  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5371  *
5372  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5373  *	device has
5374  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5375  *	supported by the driver for each vif
5376  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5377  *	supported by the driver for each peer
5378  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5379  *	long/short retry configuration
5380  *
5381  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5382  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5383  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5384  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5385  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5386  *
5387  * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5388  *	in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5389  *	by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5390  * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5391  *	the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5392  *	driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5393  * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5394  *	configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5395  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5396  *	driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5397  *	NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5398  *	legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5399  *	CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5400  */
5401 struct wiphy {
5402 	struct mutex mtx;
5403 
5404 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5405 
5406 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5407 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5408 
5409 	struct mac_address *addresses;
5410 
5411 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5412 
5413 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5414 	int n_iface_combinations;
5415 	u16 software_iftypes;
5416 
5417 	u16 n_addresses;
5418 
5419 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5420 	u16 interface_modes;
5421 
5422 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5423 
5424 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5425 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5426 
5427 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
5428 
5429 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5430 
5431 	int bss_priv_size;
5432 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
5433 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5434 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5435 	u8 max_match_sets;
5436 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5437 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5438 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5439 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5440 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5441 
5442 	int n_cipher_suites;
5443 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5444 
5445 	int n_akm_suites;
5446 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5447 
5448 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5449 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5450 
5451 	u8 retry_short;
5452 	u8 retry_long;
5453 	u32 frag_threshold;
5454 	u32 rts_threshold;
5455 	u8 coverage_class;
5456 
5457 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5458 	u32 hw_version;
5459 
5460 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5461 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5462 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5463 #endif
5464 
5465 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5466 
5467 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5468 
5469 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5470 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5471 
5472 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5473 
5474 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5475 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5476 
5477 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5478 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5479 
5480 	const void *privid;
5481 
5482 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5483 
5484 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5485 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5486 
5487 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5488 
5489 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5490 
5491 	struct device dev;
5492 
5493 	bool registered;
5494 
5495 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5496 
5497 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5498 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5499 
5500 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5501 
5502 	possible_net_t _net;
5503 
5504 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5505 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5506 #endif
5507 
5508 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5509 
5510 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5511 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5512 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5513 
5514 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5515 
5516 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5517 
5518 	u32 bss_select_support;
5519 
5520 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5521 
5522 	u32 txq_limit;
5523 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5524 	u32 txq_quantum;
5525 
5526 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5527 
5528 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5529 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5530 
5531 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5532 
5533 	struct {
5534 		u64 peer, vif;
5535 		u8 max_retry;
5536 	} tid_config_support;
5537 
5538 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5539 
5540 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5541 
5542 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5543 
5544 	u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5545 	u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5546 	u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5547 
5548 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5549 
5550 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5551 };
5552 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5553 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5554 {
5555 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5556 }
5557 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5558 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5559 {
5560 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5561 }
5562 
5563 /**
5564  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5565  *
5566  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5567  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5568  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5569 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5570 {
5571 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5572 	return &wiphy->priv;
5573 }
5574 
5575 /**
5576  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5577  *
5578  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5579  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5580  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5581 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5582 {
5583 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5584 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5585 }
5586 
5587 /**
5588  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5589  *
5590  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5591  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5592  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5593 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5594 {
5595 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5596 }
5597 
5598 /**
5599  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5600  *
5601  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5602  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5603  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5604 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5605 {
5606 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5607 }
5608 
5609 /**
5610  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5611  *
5612  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5613  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5614  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5615 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5616 {
5617 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5618 }
5619 
5620 /**
5621  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5622  *
5623  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5624  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5625  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5626  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5627  *
5628  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5629  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5630  *
5631  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5632  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5633  */
5634 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5635 			   const char *requested_name);
5636 
5637 /**
5638  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5639  *
5640  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5641  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5642  *
5643  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5644  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5645  *
5646  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5647  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5648  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5649 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5650 				      int sizeof_priv)
5651 {
5652 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5653 }
5654 
5655 /**
5656  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5657  *
5658  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5659  *
5660  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5661  */
5662 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5663 
5664 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5665 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5666 
5667 /**
5668  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5669  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5670  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5671  *
5672  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5673  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5674  */
5675 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5676         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5677 
5678 /**
5679  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5680  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5681  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5682  *
5683  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5684  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5685  */
5686 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5687         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5688 
5689 /**
5690  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5691  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5692  */
5693 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5694 
5695 /**
5696  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5697  *
5698  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5699  *
5700  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5701  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5702  * request that is being handled.
5703  */
5704 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5705 
5706 /**
5707  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5708  *
5709  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5710  */
5711 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5712 
5713 /* internal structs */
5714 struct cfg80211_conn;
5715 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5716 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5717 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5718 
5719 /**
5720  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5721  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5722  *
5723  * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5724  * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5725  * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5726  * differentiate which way it's called.
5727  *
5728  * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5729  *
5730  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5731  *
5732  * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5733  * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5734  */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5735 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5736 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5737 {
5738 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5739 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5740 }
5741 
5742 /**
5743  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5744  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5745  */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5746 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5747 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5748 {
5749 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5750 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5751 }
5752 
5753 struct wiphy_work;
5754 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5755 
5756 struct wiphy_work {
5757 	struct list_head entry;
5758 	wiphy_work_func_t func;
5759 };
5760 
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)5761 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5762 				   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5763 {
5764 	INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5765 	work->func = func;
5766 }
5767 
5768 /**
5769  * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5770  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5771  * @work: the work item
5772  *
5773  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5774  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5775  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5776  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5777  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5778  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5779  */
5780 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5781 
5782 /**
5783  * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
5784  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5785  * @work: the work to cancel
5786  *
5787  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5788  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5789  */
5790 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5791 
5792 /**
5793  * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
5794  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5795  * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
5796  *
5797  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5798  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5799  */
5800 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5801 
5802 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
5803 	struct wiphy_work work;
5804 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5805 	struct timer_list timer;
5806 };
5807 
5808 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
5809 
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)5810 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5811 					   wiphy_work_func_t func)
5812 {
5813 	timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
5814 	wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
5815 }
5816 
5817 /**
5818  * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
5819  * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5820  * @dwork: the delayable worker
5821  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5822  *
5823  * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5824  * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5825  * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5826  * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5827  * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5828  * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5829  */
5830 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5831 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5832 			      unsigned long delay);
5833 
5834 /**
5835  * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
5836  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5837  * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
5838  *
5839  * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5840  * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5841  */
5842 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5843 			       struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5844 
5845 /**
5846  * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
5847  * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5848  * @work: the work to flush
5849  *
5850  * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5851  * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5852  */
5853 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5854 			      struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5855 
5856 /**
5857  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5858  *
5859  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5860  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5861  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5862  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5863  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5864  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
5865  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
5866  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
5867  *
5868  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5869  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5870  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5871  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5872  *
5873  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5874  * @iftype: interface type
5875  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
5876  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
5877  *	for the notifier
5878  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5879  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5880  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5881  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5882  * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
5883  * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
5884  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5885  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5886  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5887  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5888  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5889  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5890  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5891  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5892  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5893  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5894  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5895  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5896  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5897  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5898  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5899  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5900  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5901  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5902  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5903  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5904  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5905  *	and some API functions require it held
5906  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5907  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5908  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5909  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5910  *	the P2P Device.
5911  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5912  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5913  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5914  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5915  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5916  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5917  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5918  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5919  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5920  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5921  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5922  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5923  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5924  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5925  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5926  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5927  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5928  * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
5929  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5930  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5931  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5932  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5933  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5934  *	unprotected beacon report
5935  * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
5936  *	@ap and @client for each link
5937  * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
5938  */
5939 struct wireless_dev {
5940 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5941 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5942 
5943 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5944 	struct list_head list;
5945 	struct net_device *netdev;
5946 
5947 	u32 identifier;
5948 
5949 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5950 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5951 
5952 	struct mutex mtx;
5953 
5954 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
5955 
5956 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5957 
5958 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5959 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5960 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5961 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5962 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5963 
5964 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5965 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5966 
5967 	struct list_head event_list;
5968 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5969 
5970 	u8 connected:1;
5971 
5972 	bool ps;
5973 	int ps_timeout;
5974 
5975 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5976 
5977 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5978 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5979 
5980 	/* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
5981 	bool cac_started;
5982 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5983 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5984 
5985 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5986 	/* wext data */
5987 	struct {
5988 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5989 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5990 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5991 		const u8 *ie;
5992 		size_t ie_len;
5993 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5994 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5995 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5996 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5997 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5998 	} wext;
5999 #endif
6000 
6001 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
6002 
6003 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
6004 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6005 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6006 
6007 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6008 
6009 	union {
6010 		struct {
6011 			u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6012 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6013 			u8 ssid_len;
6014 		} client;
6015 		struct {
6016 			int beacon_interval;
6017 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6018 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6019 			u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6020 			u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6021 		} mesh;
6022 		struct {
6023 			struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6024 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6025 			u8 ssid_len;
6026 		} ap;
6027 		struct {
6028 			struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6029 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6030 			int beacon_interval;
6031 			u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6032 			u8 ssid_len;
6033 		} ibss;
6034 		struct {
6035 			struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6036 		} ocb;
6037 	} u;
6038 
6039 	struct {
6040 		u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6041 		union {
6042 			struct {
6043 				unsigned int beacon_interval;
6044 				struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6045 			} ap;
6046 			struct {
6047 				struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6048 			} client;
6049 		};
6050 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6051 	u16 valid_links;
6052 
6053 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
6054 	ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
6055 };
6056 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6057 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6058 {
6059 	if (wdev->netdev)
6060 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6061 	return wdev->address;
6062 }
6063 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6064 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6065 {
6066 	if (wdev->netdev)
6067 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6068 	return wdev->is_running;
6069 }
6070 
6071 /**
6072  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6073  *
6074  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6075  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6076  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6077 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6078 {
6079 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
6080 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6081 }
6082 
6083 /**
6084  * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6085  * @wdev: the wdev
6086  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6087  *
6088  * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6089  */
6090 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6091 				       unsigned int link_id);
6092 
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6093 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6094 					unsigned int link_id)
6095 {
6096 	WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6097 	WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6098 		!(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6099 }
6100 
6101 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id)			\
6102 	for (link_id = 0;					\
6103 	     link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ?		\
6104 			ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1);	\
6105 	     link_id++)						\
6106 		if (!(link_info)->valid_links ||		\
6107 		    ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6108 
6109 /**
6110  * DOC: Utility functions
6111  *
6112  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6113  */
6114 
6115 /**
6116  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6117  *
6118  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6119  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6120  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6121  */
6122 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6123 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6124 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6125 {
6126 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6127 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6128 }
6129 
6130 /**
6131  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6132  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6133  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6134  */
6135 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6136 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6137 {
6138 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6139 }
6140 
6141 /**
6142  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6143  *
6144  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6145  * @chan: channel
6146  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6147  */
6148 enum nl80211_chan_width
6149 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6150 
6151 /**
6152  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6153  * @chan: channel number
6154  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6155  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6156  */
6157 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6158 
6159 /**
6160  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6161  * @chan: channel number
6162  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6163  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6164  */
6165 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6166 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6167 {
6168 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6169 }
6170 
6171 /**
6172  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6173  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6174  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6175  */
6176 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6177 
6178 /**
6179  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6180  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6181  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6182  */
6183 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6184 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6185 {
6186 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6187 }
6188 
6189 /**
6190  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6191  * frequency
6192  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6193  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6194  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6195  */
6196 struct ieee80211_channel *
6197 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6198 
6199 /**
6200  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6201  *
6202  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6203  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6204  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6205  */
6206 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6207 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6208 {
6209 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6210 }
6211 
6212 /**
6213  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6214  * @chan: control channel to check
6215  *
6216  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6217  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6218  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6219 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6220 {
6221 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6222 		return false;
6223 
6224 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6225 }
6226 
6227 /**
6228  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6229  *
6230  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6231  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6232  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6233  *
6234  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6235  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6236  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6237  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6238  */
6239 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6240 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6241 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6242 
6243 /**
6244  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6245  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6246  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
6247  *
6248  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
6249  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6250  */
6251 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6252 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
6253 
6254 /*
6255  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6256  *
6257  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6258  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6259  */
6260 
6261 struct radiotap_align_size {
6262 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6263 };
6264 
6265 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6266 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6267 	int n_bits;
6268 	uint32_t oui;
6269 	uint8_t subns;
6270 };
6271 
6272 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6273 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6274 	int n_ns;
6275 };
6276 
6277 /**
6278  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6279  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6280  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6281  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6282  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6283  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6284  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
6285  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6286  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6287  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6288  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6289  *	radiotap namespace or not
6290  *
6291  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6292  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6293  * @_arg_index: next argument index
6294  * @_arg: next argument pointer
6295  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6296  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6297  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6298  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6299  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6300  *	next bitmap word
6301  *
6302  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6303  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6304  */
6305 
6306 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6307 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6308 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6309 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6310 
6311 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6312 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
6313 
6314 	unsigned char *this_arg;
6315 	int this_arg_index;
6316 	int this_arg_size;
6317 
6318 	int is_radiotap_ns;
6319 
6320 	int _max_length;
6321 	int _arg_index;
6322 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6323 	int _reset_on_ext;
6324 };
6325 
6326 int
6327 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6328 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6329 				 int max_length,
6330 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6331 
6332 int
6333 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6334 
6335 
6336 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6337 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6338 
6339 /**
6340  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6341  *
6342  * @skb: the frame
6343  *
6344  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6345  * returns the 802.11 header length.
6346  *
6347  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6348  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6349  * 802.11 header.
6350  */
6351 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6352 
6353 /**
6354  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6355  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6356  * Return: The header length in bytes.
6357  */
6358 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6359 
6360 /**
6361  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6362  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6363  *	(first byte) will be accessed
6364  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6365  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6366  */
6367 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6368 
6369 /**
6370  * DOC: Data path helpers
6371  *
6372  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6373  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6374  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6375  */
6376 
6377 /**
6378  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6379  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6380  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6381  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
6382  * @addr: the device MAC address
6383  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6384  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6385  * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6386  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6387  */
6388 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6389 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6390 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6391 
6392 /**
6393  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6394  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6395  * @addr: the device MAC address
6396  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6397  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6398  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6399 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6400 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6401 {
6402 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6403 }
6404 
6405 /**
6406  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6407  *
6408  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6409  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6410  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6411  *
6412  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6413  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6414  *	initialized by the caller.
6415  * @addr: The device MAC address.
6416  * @iftype: The device interface type.
6417  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6418  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6419  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6420  */
6421 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6422 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6423 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6424 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
6425 
6426 /**
6427  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6428  * @skb: the data frame
6429  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6430  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6431  */
6432 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6433 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6434 
6435 /**
6436  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6437  *
6438  * @eid: element ID
6439  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6440  * @len: length of data
6441  * @match: byte array to match
6442  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6443  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6444  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6445  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6446  *	the data portion instead.
6447  *
6448  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6449  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6450  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6451  * requested element struct.
6452  *
6453  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6454  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6455  * byte array to match.
6456  */
6457 const struct element *
6458 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6459 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6460 			 unsigned int match_offset);
6461 
6462 /**
6463  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6464  *
6465  * @eid: element ID
6466  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6467  * @len: length of data
6468  * @match: byte array to match
6469  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6470  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6471  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6472  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6473  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6474  *	the second byte is the IE length.
6475  *
6476  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6477  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6478  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6479  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6480  * element ID.
6481  *
6482  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6483  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6484  * byte array to match.
6485  */
6486 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6487 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6488 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6489 		       unsigned int match_offset)
6490 {
6491 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6492 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6493 	 */
6494 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6495 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
6496 		return NULL;
6497 
6498 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6499 						      match, match_len,
6500 						      match_offset ?
6501 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
6502 }
6503 
6504 /**
6505  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6506  *
6507  * @eid: element ID
6508  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6509  * @len: length of data
6510  *
6511  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6512  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6513  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6514  * requested element struct.
6515  *
6516  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6517  * having to fit into the given data.
6518  */
6519 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6520 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6521 {
6522 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6523 }
6524 
6525 /**
6526  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6527  *
6528  * @eid: element ID
6529  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6530  * @len: length of data
6531  *
6532  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6533  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6534  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6535  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6536  *
6537  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6538  * having to fit into the given data.
6539  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6540 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6541 {
6542 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6543 }
6544 
6545 /**
6546  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6547  *
6548  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6549  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6550  * @len: length of data
6551  *
6552  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
6553  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6554  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6555  * requested element struct.
6556  *
6557  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6558  * having to fit into the given data.
6559  */
6560 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6561 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6562 {
6563 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6564 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
6565 }
6566 
6567 /**
6568  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6569  *
6570  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6571  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6572  * @len: length of data
6573  *
6574  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6575  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6576  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6577  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6578  *
6579  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6580  * having to fit into the given data.
6581  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6582 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6583 {
6584 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6585 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6586 }
6587 
6588 /**
6589  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6590  *
6591  * @oui: vendor OUI
6592  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6593  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6594  * @len: length of data
6595  *
6596  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6597  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6598  * return the element structure for the requested element.
6599  *
6600  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6601  * the given data.
6602  */
6603 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6604 						const u8 *ies,
6605 						unsigned int len);
6606 
6607 /**
6608  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6609  *
6610  * @oui: vendor OUI
6611  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6612  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6613  * @len: length of data
6614  *
6615  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6616  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6617  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6618  * element ID.
6619  *
6620  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6621  * the given data.
6622  */
6623 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)6624 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6625 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6626 {
6627 	return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6628 }
6629 
6630 /**
6631  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6632  *
6633  * @dev: network device
6634  * @addr: STA MAC address
6635  *
6636  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6637  * devices upon STA association.
6638  */
6639 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6640 
6641 /**
6642  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6643  *
6644  * TODO
6645  */
6646 
6647 /**
6648  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6649  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6650  *	conflicts)
6651  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6652  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6653  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6654  *	alpha2.
6655  *
6656  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6657  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6658  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6659  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6660  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6661  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6662  *
6663  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6664  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6665  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6666  *
6667  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6668  * an -ENOMEM.
6669  *
6670  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6671  */
6672 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6673 
6674 /**
6675  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6676  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6677  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
6678  *
6679  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6680  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6681  * information.
6682  *
6683  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6684  */
6685 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6686 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6687 
6688 /**
6689  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6690  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6691  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6692  *
6693  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6694  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6695  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6696  *
6697  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6698  */
6699 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6700 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6701 
6702 /**
6703  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6704  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6705  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6706  *
6707  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6708  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6709  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6710  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6711  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6712  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6713  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6714  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6715  * that called this helper.
6716  */
6717 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6718 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6719 
6720 /**
6721  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6722  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6723  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6724  *
6725  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6726  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6727  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6728  * and processed already.
6729  *
6730  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6731  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6732  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6733  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6734  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6735  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6736  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6737  */
6738 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6739 					       u32 center_freq);
6740 
6741 /**
6742  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6743  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6744  *
6745  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6746  * proper string representation.
6747  */
6748 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6749 
6750 /**
6751  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6752  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6753  *
6754  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6755  */
6756 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6757 
6758 /**
6759  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6760  *
6761  */
6762 
6763 /**
6764  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6765  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6766  *
6767  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6768  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6769  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6770  *
6771  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6772  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6773  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6774  *
6775  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6776  * an -ENODATA.
6777  *
6778  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6779  */
6780 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6781 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6782 
6783 /*
6784  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6785  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6786  */
6787 
6788 /**
6789  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6790  *
6791  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6792  * @info: information about the completed scan
6793  */
6794 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6795 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6796 
6797 /**
6798  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6799  *
6800  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6801  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6802  */
6803 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6804 
6805 /**
6806  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6807  *
6808  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6809  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6810  *
6811  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6812  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6813  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6814  */
6815 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6816 
6817 /**
6818  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6819  *
6820  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6821  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6822  *
6823  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6824  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6825  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6826  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6827  */
6828 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6829 
6830 /**
6831  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6832  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6833  * @data: the BSS metadata
6834  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6835  * @len: length of the management frame
6836  * @gfp: context flags
6837  *
6838  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6839  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6840  *
6841  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6842  * Or %NULL on error.
6843  */
6844 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6845 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6846 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6847 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6848 			       gfp_t gfp);
6849 
6850 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6851 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6852 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6853 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6854 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6855 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6856 {
6857 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6858 		.chan = rx_channel,
6859 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6860 		.signal = signal,
6861 	};
6862 
6863 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6864 }
6865 
6866 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6867 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6868 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6869 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6870 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6871 {
6872 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6873 		.chan = rx_channel,
6874 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6875 		.signal = signal,
6876 	};
6877 
6878 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6879 }
6880 
6881 /**
6882  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6883  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6884  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6885  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6886  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6887  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)6888 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6889 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6890 {
6891 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6892 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6893 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6894 
6895 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6896 
6897 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6898 
6899 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6900 }
6901 
6902 /**
6903  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6904  * @element: element to check
6905  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6906  */
6907 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6908 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6909 
6910 /**
6911  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6912  * @ie: ies
6913  * @ielen: length of IEs
6914  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6915  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6916  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6917  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6918  */
6919 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6920 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6921 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6922 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6923 
6924 /**
6925  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6926  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6927  *	from a beacon or probe response
6928  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6929  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6930  */
6931 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6932 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6933 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6934 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6935 };
6936 
6937 /**
6938  * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
6939  * @ie: IEs
6940  * @ielen: length of IEs
6941  * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
6942  * @ftype: frame type
6943  *
6944  * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
6945  */
6946 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6947 				    enum nl80211_band band,
6948 				    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype);
6949 
6950 /**
6951  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6952  *
6953  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6954  * @data: the BSS metadata
6955  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6956  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6957  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6958  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6959  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6960  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6961  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6962  * @gfp: context flags
6963  *
6964  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6965  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6966  *
6967  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6968  * Or %NULL on error.
6969  */
6970 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6971 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6972 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6973 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6974 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6975 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6976 			 gfp_t gfp);
6977 
6978 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6979 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6980 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6981 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6982 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6983 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6984 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6985 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6986 {
6987 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6988 		.chan = rx_channel,
6989 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6990 		.signal = signal,
6991 	};
6992 
6993 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6994 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6995 					gfp);
6996 }
6997 
6998 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6999 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7000 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7001 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7002 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7003 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7004 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7005 {
7006 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7007 		.chan = rx_channel,
7008 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
7009 		.signal = signal,
7010 	};
7011 
7012 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7013 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7014 					gfp);
7015 }
7016 
7017 /**
7018  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7019  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7020  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7021  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7022  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7023  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7024  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7025  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7026  */
7027 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7028 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7029 				      const u8 *bssid,
7030 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7031 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7032 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
7033 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7034 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7035 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7036 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7037 {
7038 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7039 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7040 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7041 }
7042 
7043 /**
7044  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7045  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7046  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7047  *
7048  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7049  */
7050 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7051 
7052 /**
7053  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7054  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7055  * @bss: the BSS struct
7056  *
7057  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7058  */
7059 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7060 
7061 /**
7062  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7063  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7064  * @bss: the bss to remove
7065  *
7066  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7067  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7068  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7069  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7070  */
7071 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7072 
7073 /**
7074  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7075  *
7076  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7077  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7078  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7079  *
7080  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7081  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7082  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7083  * @iter: the iterator function to call
7084  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7085  */
7086 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7087 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7088 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7089 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7090 				    void *data),
7091 		       void *iter_data);
7092 
7093 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)7094 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7095 {
7096 	switch (chandef->width) {
7097 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
7098 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
7099 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
7100 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
7101 	default:
7102 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7103 	}
7104 }
7105 
7106 /**
7107  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7108  * @dev: network device
7109  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7110  * @len: length of the frame data
7111  *
7112  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7113  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7114  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7115  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7116  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7117  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7118  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7119  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7120  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7121  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7122  *
7123  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7124  */
7125 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7126 
7127 /**
7128  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7129  * @dev: network device
7130  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7131  *
7132  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7133  * mutex.
7134  */
7135 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7136 
7137 /**
7138  * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - association response data
7139  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
7140  *	moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7141  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7142  * @len: length of the frame data
7143  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7144  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7145  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7146  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7147  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7148  * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7149  *	non-MLO connections
7150  * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7151  *	were rejected by the AP.
7152  */
7153 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp {
7154 	const u8 *buf;
7155 	size_t len;
7156 	const u8 *req_ies;
7157 	size_t req_ies_len;
7158 	int uapsd_queues;
7159 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7160 	struct {
7161 		const u8 *addr;
7162 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7163 		u16 status;
7164 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7165 };
7166 
7167 /**
7168  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7169  * @dev: network device
7170  * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp
7171  *
7172  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7173  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7174  *
7175  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7176  */
7177 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7178 			    struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp *data);
7179 
7180 /**
7181  * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7182  * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7183  * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7184  *	(@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7185  * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7186  *	the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7187  *	other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7188  */
7189 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7190 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7191 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7192 	bool timeout;
7193 };
7194 
7195 /**
7196  * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7197  * @dev: network device
7198  * @data: data describing the association failure
7199  *
7200  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7201  */
7202 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7203 			    struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7204 
7205 /**
7206  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7207  * @dev: network device
7208  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7209  * @len: length of the frame data
7210  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7211  *
7212  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7213  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7214  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7215  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7216  */
7217 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7218 			   bool reconnect);
7219 
7220 /**
7221  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7222  * @dev: network device
7223  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7224  * @len: length of the frame data
7225  *
7226  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7227  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7228  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7229  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7230  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7231  *
7232  * This function may sleep.
7233  */
7234 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7235 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7236 
7237 /**
7238  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7239  * @dev: network device
7240  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7241  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7242  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7243  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7244  * @gfp: allocation flags
7245  *
7246  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7247  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7248  * primitive.
7249  */
7250 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7251 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7252 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7253 
7254 /**
7255  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7256  *
7257  * @dev: network device
7258  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7259  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7260  * @gfp: allocation flags
7261  *
7262  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7263  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7264  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7265  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7266  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7267  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7268  */
7269 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7270 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7271 
7272 /**
7273  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7274  * 					candidate
7275  *
7276  * @dev: network device
7277  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7278  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7279  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7280  * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7281  * @gfp: allocation flags
7282  *
7283  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7284  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7285  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7286  */
7287 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7288 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7289 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7290 
7291 /**
7292  * DOC: RFkill integration
7293  *
7294  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7295  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7296  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7297  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
7298  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7299  *
7300  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7301  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7302  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7303  */
7304 
7305 /**
7306  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7307  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7308  * @blocked: block status
7309  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7310  */
7311 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7312 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7313 
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7314 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7315 {
7316 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7317 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7318 }
7319 
7320 /**
7321  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7322  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7323  */
7324 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7325 
7326 /**
7327  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7328  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7329  */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7330 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7331 {
7332 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7333 }
7334 
7335 /**
7336  * DOC: Vendor commands
7337  *
7338  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7339  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7340  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7341  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7342  * the configuration mechanism.
7343  *
7344  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7345  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
7346  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7347  *
7348  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7349  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7350  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7351  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7352  * managers etc. need.
7353  */
7354 
7355 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7356 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7357 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7358 					   int approxlen);
7359 
7360 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7361 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7362 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7363 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7364 					   unsigned int portid,
7365 					   int vendor_event_idx,
7366 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7367 
7368 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7369 
7370 /**
7371  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7372  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7373  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7374  *	be put into the skb
7375  *
7376  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7377  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7378  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7379  *
7380  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7381  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7382  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7383  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7384  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7385  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7386  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7387  *
7388  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7389  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7390  *
7391  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7392  */
7393 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7394 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7395 {
7396 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7397 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7398 }
7399 
7400 /**
7401  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7402  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7403  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7404  *
7405  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7406  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7407  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
7408  * skb regardless of the return value.
7409  *
7410  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7411  */
7412 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7413 
7414 /**
7415  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7416  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7417  *
7418  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7419  * Valid to call only there.
7420  */
7421 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7422 
7423 /**
7424  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7425  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7426  * @wdev: the wireless device
7427  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7428  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7429  *	be put into the skb
7430  * @gfp: allocation flags
7431  *
7432  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7433  * vendor-specific multicast group.
7434  *
7435  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7436  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7437  * attribute.
7438  *
7439  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7440  * skb to send the event.
7441  *
7442  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7443  */
7444 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7445 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7446 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7447 {
7448 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7449 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7450 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7451 }
7452 
7453 /**
7454  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7455  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7456  * @wdev: the wireless device
7457  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7458  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7459  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7460  *	be put into the skb
7461  * @gfp: allocation flags
7462  *
7463  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7464  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7465  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7466  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7467  *
7468  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7469  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7470  * attribute.
7471  *
7472  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7473  * skb to send the event.
7474  *
7475  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7476  */
7477 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7478 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7479 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7480 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7481 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7482 {
7483 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7484 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7485 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7486 }
7487 
7488 /**
7489  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7490  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7491  * @gfp: allocation flags
7492  *
7493  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7494  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7495  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7496 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7497 {
7498 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7499 }
7500 
7501 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7502 /**
7503  * DOC: Test mode
7504  *
7505  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7506  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7507  * factory programming.
7508  *
7509  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
7510  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7511  */
7512 
7513 /**
7514  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7515  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7516  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7517  *	be put into the skb
7518  *
7519  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7520  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7521  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7522  *
7523  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7524  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7525  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7526  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7527  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7528  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7529  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7530  *
7531  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7532  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7533  *
7534  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7535  */
7536 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7537 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7538 {
7539 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7540 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7541 }
7542 
7543 /**
7544  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7545  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7546  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7547  *
7548  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7549  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7550  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
7551  * regardless of the return value.
7552  *
7553  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7554  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)7555 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7556 {
7557 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7558 }
7559 
7560 /**
7561  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7562  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7563  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7564  *	be put into the skb
7565  * @gfp: allocation flags
7566  *
7567  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7568  * testmode multicast group.
7569  *
7570  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7571  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7572  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7573  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7574  * in any other way.
7575  *
7576  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7577  * skb to send the event.
7578  *
7579  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7580  */
7581 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)7582 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7583 {
7584 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7585 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7586 					  approxlen, gfp);
7587 }
7588 
7589 /**
7590  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7591  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7592  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7593  * @gfp: allocation flags
7594  *
7595  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7596  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7597  * consumes it.
7598  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7599 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7600 {
7601 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7602 }
7603 
7604 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7605 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
7606 #else
7607 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7608 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7609 #endif
7610 
7611 /**
7612  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7613  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7614  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7615  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7616  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7617  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7618  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7619  *	status for a FILS connection.
7620  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7621  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7622  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7623  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7624  */
7625 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7626 	const u8 *kek;
7627 	size_t kek_len;
7628 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7629 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7630 	const u8 *pmk;
7631 	size_t pmk_len;
7632 	const u8 *pmkid;
7633 };
7634 
7635 /**
7636  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7637  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7638  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7639  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7640  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7641  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7642  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7643  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7644  *	case.
7645  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7646  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7647  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7648  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7649  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7650  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7651  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7652  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7653  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7654  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7655  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7656  * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7657  *	zero.
7658  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7659  * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7660  *	using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7661  *	connected AP info.
7662  * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7663  *	%NULL.
7664  * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7665  *	connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7666  * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7667  *	For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7668  *	is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7669  *	%NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7670  *	hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7671  *	if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7672  *	implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7673  *	to be specified.
7674  * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7675  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7676  *	@valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7677  */
7678 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7679 	int status;
7680 	const u8 *req_ie;
7681 	size_t req_ie_len;
7682 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7683 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7684 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7685 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7686 
7687 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7688 	u16 valid_links;
7689 	struct {
7690 		const u8 *addr;
7691 		const u8 *bssid;
7692 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7693 		u16 status;
7694 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7695 };
7696 
7697 /**
7698  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7699  *
7700  * @dev: network device
7701  * @params: connection response parameters
7702  * @gfp: allocation flags
7703  *
7704  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7705  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7706  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7707  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7708  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7709  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7710  */
7711 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7712 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7713 			   gfp_t gfp);
7714 
7715 /**
7716  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7717  *
7718  * @dev: network device
7719  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7720  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7721  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7722  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7723  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7724  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7725  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7726  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7727  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7728  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7729  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7730  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7731  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7732  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7733  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7734  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7735  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7736  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7737  *	case.
7738  * @gfp: allocation flags
7739  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7740  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7741  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7742  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7743  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7744  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7745  *
7746  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7747  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7748  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7749  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7750  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7751  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7752  */
7753 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)7754 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7755 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7756 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7757 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7758 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7759 {
7760 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7761 
7762 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7763 	params.status = status;
7764 	params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
7765 	params.links[0].bss = bss;
7766 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7767 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7768 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7769 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7770 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7771 
7772 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7773 }
7774 
7775 /**
7776  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7777  *
7778  * @dev: network device
7779  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7780  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7781  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7782  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7783  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7784  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7785  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7786  *	the real status code for failures.
7787  * @gfp: allocation flags
7788  *
7789  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7790  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7791  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7792  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7793  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7794  */
7795 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)7796 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7797 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7798 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7799 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7800 {
7801 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7802 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7803 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7804 }
7805 
7806 /**
7807  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7808  *
7809  * @dev: network device
7810  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7811  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7812  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7813  * @gfp: allocation flags
7814  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7815  *
7816  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7817  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7818  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7819  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7820  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7821  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7822  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7823  */
7824 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)7825 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7826 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7827 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7828 {
7829 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7830 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
7831 }
7832 
7833 /**
7834  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7835  *
7836  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7837  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7838  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7839  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7840  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7841  * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
7842  *	Otherwise zero.
7843  * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7844  * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
7845  *	@valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
7846  * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
7847  * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
7848  *	roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
7849  *	%NULL if %links.bss is set.
7850  * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
7851  * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
7852  *	roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
7853  *	which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
7854  */
7855 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7856 	const u8 *req_ie;
7857 	size_t req_ie_len;
7858 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7859 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7860 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7861 
7862 	const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7863 	u16 valid_links;
7864 	struct {
7865 		const u8 *addr;
7866 		const u8 *bssid;
7867 		struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7868 		struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7869 	} links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7870 };
7871 
7872 /**
7873  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7874  *
7875  * @dev: network device
7876  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7877  * @gfp: allocation flags
7878  *
7879  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7880  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7881  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7882  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7883  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7884  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7885  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7886  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7887  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7888  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7889  */
7890 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7891 		     gfp_t gfp);
7892 
7893 /**
7894  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7895  *
7896  * @dev: network device
7897  * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
7898  *	in case of AP/P2P GO
7899  * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
7900  * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
7901  * @gfp: allocation flags
7902  *
7903  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7904  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7905  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7906  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7907  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7908  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7909  * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
7910  * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
7911  * associated STA/GC.
7912  */
7913 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
7914 			      const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
7915 
7916 /**
7917  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7918  *
7919  * @dev: network device
7920  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7921  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7922  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7923  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7924  * @gfp: allocation flags
7925  *
7926  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7927  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7928  */
7929 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7930 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7931 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7932 
7933 /**
7934  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7935  * @wdev: wireless device
7936  * @cookie: the request cookie
7937  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7938  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7939  *	channel
7940  * @gfp: allocation flags
7941  */
7942 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7943 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7944 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7945 
7946 /**
7947  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7948  * @wdev: wireless device
7949  * @cookie: the request cookie
7950  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7951  * @gfp: allocation flags
7952  */
7953 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7954 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7955 					gfp_t gfp);
7956 
7957 /**
7958  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7959  * @wdev: wireless device
7960  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7961  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7962  * @gfp: allocation flags
7963  */
7964 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7965 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7966 
7967 /**
7968  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7969  *
7970  * @sinfo: the station information
7971  * @gfp: allocation flags
7972  */
7973 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7974 
7975 /**
7976  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7977  * @sinfo: the station information
7978  *
7979  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7980  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7981  * the stack.)
7982  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)7983 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7984 {
7985 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7986 }
7987 
7988 /**
7989  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7990  *
7991  * @dev: the netdev
7992  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7993  * @sinfo: the station information
7994  * @gfp: allocation flags
7995  */
7996 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7997 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7998 
7999 /**
8000  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8001  * @dev: the netdev
8002  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8003  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8004  * @gfp: allocation flags
8005  */
8006 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8007 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8008 
8009 /**
8010  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8011  *
8012  * @dev: the netdev
8013  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8014  * @gfp: allocation flags
8015  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8016 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8017 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8018 {
8019 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8020 }
8021 
8022 /**
8023  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8024  *
8025  * @dev: the netdev
8026  * @mac_addr: the station's address
8027  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8028  * @gfp: allocation flags
8029  *
8030  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8031  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8032  * for some reasons, this function is called.
8033  *
8034  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8035  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8036  */
8037 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8038 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8039 			  gfp_t gfp);
8040 
8041 /**
8042  * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8043  *
8044  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8045  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8046  * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8047  *	an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8048  * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received	on
8049  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8050  * @len: length of the frame data
8051  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8052  * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8053  * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8054  */
8055 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8056 	int freq;
8057 	int sig_dbm;
8058 	bool have_link_id;
8059 	u8 link_id;
8060 	const u8 *buf;
8061 	size_t len;
8062 	u32 flags;
8063 	u64 rx_tstamp;
8064 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8065 };
8066 
8067 /**
8068  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8069  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8070  * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8071  *
8072  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8073  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8074  *
8075  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8076  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8077  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8078  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8079  */
8080 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8081 			  struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8082 
8083 /**
8084  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8085  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8086  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8087  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8088  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8089  * @len: length of the frame data
8090  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8091  *
8092  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8093  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8094  *
8095  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8096  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8097  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8098  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8099  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8100 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8101 					int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8102 					u32 flags)
8103 {
8104 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8105 		.freq = freq,
8106 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8107 		.buf = buf,
8108 		.len = len,
8109 		.flags = flags
8110 	};
8111 
8112 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8113 }
8114 
8115 /**
8116  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8117  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8118  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8119  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8120  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8121  * @len: length of the frame data
8122  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8123  *
8124  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8125  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8126  *
8127  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8128  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8129  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8130  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8131  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8132 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8133 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8134 				    u32 flags)
8135 {
8136 	struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8137 		.freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8138 		.sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8139 		.buf = buf,
8140 		.len = len,
8141 		.flags = flags
8142 	};
8143 
8144 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8145 }
8146 
8147 /**
8148  * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8149  *
8150  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8151  * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8152  * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8153  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8154  * @len: length of the frame data
8155  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8156  */
8157 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8158 	u64 cookie;
8159 	u64 tx_tstamp;
8160 	u64 ack_tstamp;
8161 	const u8 *buf;
8162 	size_t len;
8163 	bool ack;
8164 };
8165 
8166 /**
8167  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8168  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8169  * @status: TX status data
8170  * @gfp: context flags
8171  *
8172  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8173  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8174  * transmission attempt with extended info.
8175  */
8176 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8177 				 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8178 
8179 /**
8180  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8181  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8182  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8183  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8184  * @len: length of the frame data
8185  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8186  * @gfp: context flags
8187  *
8188  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8189  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8190  * transmission attempt.
8191  */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8192 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8193 					   u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8194 					   size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8195 {
8196 	struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8197 		.cookie = cookie,
8198 		.buf = buf,
8199 		.len = len,
8200 		.ack = ack
8201 	};
8202 
8203 	cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8204 }
8205 
8206 /**
8207  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8208  *                                   port frames
8209  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8210  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8211  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8212  * @len: length of the frame data
8213  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8214  * @gfp: context flags
8215  *
8216  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8217  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8218  * the transmission attempt.
8219  */
8220 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8221 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8222 				     gfp_t gfp);
8223 
8224 /**
8225  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8226  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8227  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
8228  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
8229  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8230  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
8231  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8232  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8233  * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8234  *
8235  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8236  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8237  * control port frames over nl80211.
8238  *
8239  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8240  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8241  *
8242  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8243  */
8244 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8245 			      bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8246 
8247 /**
8248  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8249  * @dev: network device
8250  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8251  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8252  * @gfp: context flags
8253  *
8254  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8255  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8256  */
8257 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8258 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8259 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8260 
8261 /**
8262  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8263  * @dev: network device
8264  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8265  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8266  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8267  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8268  * @gfp: context flags
8269  */
8270 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8271 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8272 
8273 /**
8274  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8275  * @dev: network device
8276  * @peer: peer's MAC address
8277  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8278  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8279  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8280  * @gfp: context flags
8281  *
8282  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8283  * given interval is exceeded.
8284  */
8285 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8286 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8287 
8288 /**
8289  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8290  * @dev: network device
8291  * @gfp: context flags
8292  *
8293  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8294  */
8295 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8296 
8297 /**
8298  * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8299  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8300  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8301  * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8302  * @gfp: context flags
8303  *
8304  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8305  */
8306 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8307 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8308 			    bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8309 
8310 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8311 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8312 		     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8313 		     gfp_t gfp)
8314 {
8315 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8316 }
8317 
8318 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8319 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8320 				struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8321 				gfp_t gfp)
8322 {
8323 	__cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8324 }
8325 
8326 /**
8327  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8328  * @dev: network device
8329  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8330  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8331  * @gfp: context flags
8332  *
8333  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8334  * frame.
8335  */
8336 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8337 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8338 				       gfp_t gfp);
8339 
8340 /**
8341  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8342  * @netdev: network device
8343  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8344  * @event: type of event
8345  * @gfp: context flags
8346  *
8347  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8348  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8349  * also by full-MAC drivers.
8350  */
8351 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8352 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8353 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8354 
8355 /**
8356  * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8357  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8358  *
8359  * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8360  * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8361  */
8362 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8363 
8364 /**
8365  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8366  * @dev: network device
8367  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8368  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8369  * @gfp: allocation flags
8370  */
8371 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8372 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8373 
8374 /**
8375  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8376  * @dev: network device
8377  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8378  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8379  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8380  * @gfp: allocation flags
8381  */
8382 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8383 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8384 
8385 /**
8386  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8387  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8388  * @addr: the transmitter address
8389  * @gfp: context flags
8390  *
8391  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8392  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8393  * sender.
8394  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8395  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8396  */
8397 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8398 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8399 
8400 /**
8401  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8402  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8403  * @addr: the transmitter address
8404  * @gfp: context flags
8405  *
8406  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8407  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8408  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8409  * station to avoid event flooding.
8410  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8411  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8412  */
8413 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8414 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8415 
8416 /**
8417  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8418  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8419  * @addr: the address of the peer
8420  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8421  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8422  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8423  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8424  * @gfp: allocation flags
8425  */
8426 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8427 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8428 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8429 
8430 /**
8431  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8432  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8433  * @frame: the frame
8434  * @len: length of the frame
8435  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8436  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8437  *
8438  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8439  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8440  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8441  */
8442 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8443 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8444 
8445 /**
8446  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8447  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8448  * @frame: the frame
8449  * @len: length of the frame
8450  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8451  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8452  *
8453  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8454  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8455  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8456  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8457 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8458 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8459 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
8460 {
8461 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8462 					sig_dbm);
8463 }
8464 
8465 /**
8466  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8467  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8468  * @chandef: the channel definition
8469  * @iftype: interface type
8470  *
8471  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8472  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8473  */
8474 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8475 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8476 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8477 
8478 /**
8479  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8480  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8481  * @chandef: the channel definition
8482  * @iftype: interface type
8483  *
8484  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8485  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8486  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8487  * more permissive conditions.
8488  *
8489  * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8490  */
8491 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8492 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8493 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8494 
8495 /*
8496  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8497  * @dev: the device which switched channels
8498  * @chandef: the new channel definition
8499  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8500  * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap
8501  *
8502  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8503  * driver context!
8504  */
8505 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8506 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8507 			       unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap);
8508 
8509 /*
8510  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8511  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8512  * @chandef: the future channel definition
8513  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8514  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8515  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8516  * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap
8517  *
8518  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8519  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8520  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8521  */
8522 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8523 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8524 				       unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8525 				       bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap);
8526 
8527 /**
8528  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8529  *
8530  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8531  * @band: band pointer to fill
8532  *
8533  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8534  */
8535 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8536 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
8537 
8538 /**
8539  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8540  *
8541  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8542  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8543  *
8544  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8545  */
8546 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8547 					  u8 *op_class);
8548 
8549 /**
8550  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8551  *
8552  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8553  *
8554  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8555  */
8556 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)8557 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8558 {
8559 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8560 }
8561 
8562 /*
8563  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8564  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8565  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8566  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8567  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8568  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8569  * @gfp: allocation flags
8570  *
8571  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8572  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8573  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8574  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8575  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8576  */
8577 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8578 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8579 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8580 
8581 /*
8582  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8583  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8584  *
8585  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
8586  */
8587 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8588 
8589 /**
8590  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8591  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8592  *
8593  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8594  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8595  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8596  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8597  * is unbound from the driver.
8598  *
8599  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8600  */
8601 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8602 
8603 /**
8604  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8605  * @dev: the netdev to register
8606  *
8607  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8608  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8609  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8610  * instead as well.
8611  *
8612  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8613  */
8614 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8615 
8616 /**
8617  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8618  * @dev: the netdev to register
8619  *
8620  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8621  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8622  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8623  * usable instead as well.
8624  *
8625  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8626  */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)8627 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8628 {
8629 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8630 }
8631 
8632 /**
8633  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8634  * @ies: FT IEs
8635  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8636  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8637  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8638  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8639  */
8640 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8641 	const u8 *ies;
8642 	size_t ies_len;
8643 	const u8 *target_ap;
8644 	const u8 *ric_ies;
8645 	size_t ric_ies_len;
8646 };
8647 
8648 /**
8649  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8650  * @netdev: network device
8651  * @ft_event: IE information
8652  */
8653 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8654 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8655 
8656 /**
8657  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8658  * @ies: the input IE buffer
8659  * @len: the input length
8660  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8661  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8662  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8663  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8664  *
8665  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
8666  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
8667  *
8668  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
8669  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
8670  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
8671  */
8672 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
8673 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
8674 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
8675 
8676 /**
8677  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
8678  * @ies: the IE buffer
8679  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8680  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8681  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8682  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8683  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8684  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
8685  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
8686  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8687  *
8688  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8689  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8690  * split.
8691  *
8692  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8693  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8694  *
8695  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8696  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8697  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8698  *
8699  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8700  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8701  * of the buffer should be used.
8702  */
8703 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8704 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
8705 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
8706 			      size_t offset);
8707 
8708 /**
8709  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
8710  * @ies: the IE buffer
8711  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8712  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8713  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8714  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8715  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8716  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8717  *
8718  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8719  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8720  * split.
8721  *
8722  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8723  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8724  *
8725  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8726  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8727  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8728  *
8729  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8730  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8731  * of the buffer should be used.
8732  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)8733 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8734 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
8735 {
8736 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
8737 }
8738 
8739 /**
8740  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
8741  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
8742  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
8743  * @gfp: allocation flags
8744  *
8745  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
8746  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
8747  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
8748  * else caused the wakeup.
8749  */
8750 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8751 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
8752 				   gfp_t gfp);
8753 
8754 /**
8755  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
8756  *
8757  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
8758  * @gfp: allocation flags
8759  *
8760  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
8761  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
8762  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
8763  */
8764 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
8765 
8766 /**
8767  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
8768  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8769  *
8770  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
8771  */
8772 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8773 
8774 /**
8775  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
8776  *
8777  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8778  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8779  *
8780  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
8781  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
8782  * the interface combinations.
8783  */
8784 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8785 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
8786 
8787 /**
8788  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
8789  *
8790  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8791  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8792  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
8793  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
8794  *
8795  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
8796  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
8797  * purposes.
8798  */
8799 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8800 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
8801 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
8802 					    void *data),
8803 			       void *data);
8804 
8805 /*
8806  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
8807  *
8808  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8809  * @wdev: wireless device
8810  * @gfp: context flags
8811  *
8812  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
8813  * disconnected.
8814  *
8815  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
8816  */
8817 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8818 			 gfp_t gfp);
8819 
8820 /**
8821  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
8822  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
8823  *
8824  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
8825  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
8826  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
8827  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
8828  *
8829  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
8830  * the driver while the function is running.
8831  */
8832 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8833 
8834 /**
8835  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8836  *
8837  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8838  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8839  *
8840  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8841  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8842  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)8843 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8844 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8845 {
8846 	u8 *ft_byte;
8847 
8848 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8849 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
8850 }
8851 
8852 /**
8853  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
8854  *
8855  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8856  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8857  *
8858  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8859  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8860  */
8861 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)8862 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8863 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8864 {
8865 	u8 ft_byte;
8866 
8867 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8868 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
8869 }
8870 
8871 /**
8872  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
8873  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
8874  *
8875  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
8876  */
8877 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
8878 
8879 /**
8880  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
8881  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
8882  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
8883  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
8884  *	 result.
8885  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
8886  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8887  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
8888  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
8889  * @info_len: the length of the &info
8890  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
8891  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
8892  */
8893 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
8894 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
8895 	u8 inst_id;
8896 	u8 peer_inst_id;
8897 	const u8 *addr;
8898 	u8 info_len;
8899 	const u8 *info;
8900 	u64 cookie;
8901 };
8902 
8903 /**
8904  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
8905  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8906  * @match: match notification parameters
8907  * @gfp: allocation flags
8908  *
8909  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
8910  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
8911  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
8912  */
8913 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8914 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
8915 
8916 /**
8917  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
8918  *
8919  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8920  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8921  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
8922  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
8923  * @gfp: allocation flags
8924  *
8925  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
8926  */
8927 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8928 				  u8 inst_id,
8929 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
8930 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
8931 
8932 /* ethtool helper */
8933 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
8934 
8935 /**
8936  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
8937  * @netdev: network device
8938  * @params: External authentication parameters
8939  * @gfp: allocation flags
8940  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
8941  */
8942 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
8943 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
8944 				   gfp_t gfp);
8945 
8946 /**
8947  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
8948  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8949  * @req: the original measurement request
8950  * @result: the result data
8951  * @gfp: allocation flags
8952  */
8953 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8954 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8955 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
8956 			  gfp_t gfp);
8957 
8958 /**
8959  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
8960  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8961  * @req: the original measurement request
8962  * @gfp: allocation flags
8963  *
8964  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
8965  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
8966  */
8967 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8968 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8969 			    gfp_t gfp);
8970 
8971 /**
8972  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
8973  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8974  * @iftype: interface type
8975  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
8976  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
8977  *
8978  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
8979  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
8980  * check_swif is '1'.
8981  */
8982 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
8983 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
8984 
8985 
8986 /**
8987  * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
8988  * temporarly rejected with a comeback
8989  * @netdev: network device
8990  * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the assocation
8991  * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
8992  *
8993  * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
8994  */
8995 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
8996 			     const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
8997 
8998 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
8999 
9000 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9001 
9002 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
9003 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9004 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9005 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9006 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9007 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9008 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9009 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9010 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9011 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9012 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9013 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9014 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9015 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9016 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9017 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9018 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9019 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9020 
9021 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9022 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9023 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
9024 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9025 
9026 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9027 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9028 
9029 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9030 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9031 
9032 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9033 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
9034 #else
9035 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
9036 ({									\
9037 	if (0)								\
9038 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
9039 	0;								\
9040 })
9041 #endif
9042 
9043 /*
9044  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9045  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9046  * file/line information and a backtrace.
9047  */
9048 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
9049 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9050 
9051 /**
9052  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9053  * @netdev: network device
9054  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9055  * @gfp: allocation flags
9056  */
9057 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9058 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9059 				    gfp_t gfp);
9060 
9061 /**
9062  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9063  * @wiphy: the wiphy
9064  */
9065 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9066 
9067 /**
9068  * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9069  * @dev: network device
9070  * @gfp: allocation flags
9071  * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9072  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9073  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9074  */
9075 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp,
9076 			      enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9077 			      u64 color_bitmap);
9078 
9079 /**
9080  * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9081  * @dev: network device
9082  * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9083  * @gfp: allocation flags
9084  */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,gfp_t gfp)9085 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9086 						       u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp)
9087 {
9088 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, gfp,
9089 					 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9090 					 0, color_bitmap);
9091 }
9092 
9093 /**
9094  * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9095  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9096  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9097  *
9098  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9099  */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count)9100 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9101 						       u8 count)
9102 {
9103 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9104 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9105 					 count, 0);
9106 }
9107 
9108 /**
9109  * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9110  * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9111  *
9112  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9113  */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev)9114 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9115 {
9116 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9117 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9118 					 0, 0);
9119 }
9120 
9121 /**
9122  * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9123  * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9124  *
9125  * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9126  */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev)9127 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9128 {
9129 	return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9130 					 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9131 					 0, 0);
9132 }
9133 
9134 /**
9135  * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap
9136  * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated
9137  * @chandef: channel definition
9138  *
9139  * Validate the puncturing bitmap.
9140  *
9141  * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise.
9142  */
9143 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap,
9144 					      const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9145 
9146 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9147